Bowman's-Weitzman's m^^i. I Jii A CONCISE, COMPREHENSIVE AND PRACTICAL TEXT-BOOK ON THE PREPARED AND EDITED WITH THE APPROVAL AND PERMISSION OF THE AUTHOR, Carl Friederich V/eitzman, BY ^IS rui'iL, e. m. bowman. TBE BIGIIT OF THASSLATWy IS HEREBY RESERVED BY THE EDITOB, Mew tfarlit WM. A. POND & CO., 23 UNION SQUARE, (Broadway, bet. 15th and 16th Sts.) 1879. * MUSIC LIBRARY UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA BERKELEY XD62 173B MUSI ^-7 ■ Entered according to Act of Congress, in the year 1877, by I ' WM. A. POND & CO., U the Office of the Librarian of Congress, Washington, D. 0. BGRKELEY MUSIC LIBRARY UNIVERSITY 0«^ CALIFORNIA ' ' / y u WVV7 'So-? ) n .J ^-te^S" '<^r TRANSLATION. The Editor of this Manual of Harmony, E. M. Bowman, pubhshes in the same his studies with me in this branch of musical art, together with an almost literal repetition of my established maxims and theorems. The course of instruction contained therein, the. concise- ness and, at the same time, the comprehensiveness of the presented rules, and the continuous alliance of the practical with the theoretical, is the fruit of experience won through extended private instruction and instruction in Conserva- tories of Music. May this, by its Editor, carefully prepared Manual be kindly received and successfully studied by the students of musical art in America. C. F. Weitzman. Berhn 1876. PKEFACE. !▼ EDITOE'S PKEFACE. Having fiinslied my course of study with the distin} lished originator of the accompanying method of instruction, I \ '^came thoroughly convinced that it was the duty of some one to j.:erma- nently record its vahiable theorems, maxims and modes of expla- nation for the benefit of not only all such as could not enjoy the personal tutorship of the author, but also for the benefit of that large number who, though having studied with him, have as yet no orderly, condensed manual of his system for reference or guid- ance in their own teaching. Urged by my revered master and fortified by his promise of assistance, I consented to undertake that which should have been the work of the author himself, and doubtless would have T)een, but for lack of opportunity formerly, coupled with enfeebled lv>alth in later years, and, mayhap, a want of appreciation for the pro- duction of his own brain, the result, let me add, of remarl ible abilities and a life-long devotion to this particular branch of mu- sical art. Thus, honored with the trust, I addressed myself during another season to the work of taking notes, ampHfying and revising page by page, under the author's kindly guidance, until at length the manuscript received the approval and indorsement set forth in the foregoing certificate. Since my return to America, I have re- ^vritten the entire work in order to still farther amplify or eliminate in parts which seemed to me to need it, and especially to improve its diction. In this latter respect, I have striven to avoid the high-sounding words, long, -complicated sentences and obscure ex- amples which too often cripple, by their vagueness, the very best intentions of theoretical writers. How far success has been at- tained in securing simphcity for these, the parts in this manual for which I alone must be responsible, is yet problematical, but the course of instruction, rules and devices for explanation, the parts which originate with Professor Weitzmann, these have been a proven success for years. They are, however, now presented for the first time, in any language, in the form of a text-book. Every one, applying himself or herself to the study of instru- mental or vocal music, ought, most assuredly, to acquire a certain V PKEPACE. degi'ee of theoretical knowledge. It. has, therefore, been the en- deavor, commencing with the very generation of sound, to embody in one volume all the theoretical education that the student of mu- sic can require to enable him. to correctly express his own musical ideas, to guide others in like attempts, and to discriminate between good and bad compositions. In its mechanical design, the work is divided into four parts covering forty chapters, a brief epitome of which may "not be mal apropos at this point. PAET I. Elementary. In tliis part will be found all that is necessary in the way of rudimentary instruction preparatory to the study of Harmony. A new departure is taken in the classification and inversion of intervals ( Chapters II and III ) which will be welcome to all un- prejudiced minds appreciating system and simplicity. PART II. Harmony. The first half of this department, ending with Chapter XXIII, treats thoroughly of triads. Beginning/ with their origin, it traces their use gradually up through the formation of modes (IV); simple triad-succession within the circle of a single mode (XIV); employment in cadences (XV); in modulation to near-related keys ( XVI ) ; then to keys more distantly related ( XVII ) ; next in successions not common to the same mode (XVIII); of dis- sonant triads (XIX ), and finally their use in the harmonization of a given melody ( XXIII ) . The tiiad is the fundamental harmony. All other tone-combi- nations whatsoever, are derived from, and must finally return to it. A solid sub-structure, formed through thorough practice in triad- succession alone,' is one of the salient features of the Weitzmann system. This is the gradually developed central idea of Part II up to Chapter XXIII, with deviations here and there to the accom- panying subjects of Melody, Meter, Rhythm, etc. A substantial foundation having been laid, the superstructure is -flext in order. Accordingly, in the last half of this department, the derivative chords are treated of : Suspensions ( XXIII ) ; Chords of the Seventh (XXIV-XXXI) ; the so-called' Chords of the Ninth, Eleventh, and Thirteenth (XXXII); and Altered Ac- cords (XXXIII). PREFACE. ■^ Attention is directed to the new and original method of explain- ing and testing the resolution of dissonant chords. Its full text ^vill be found in Chapter XXVIII. The so-called Chords of the Ninth, Eleventh, and Thirteenth are presented in a light which will make their comprehension and treatment far less comphcated than hitherto. PAKT III. Simple Counterpoint. In this department it has been the design to treat of the melodic phase of harmonic comj)osition. To this end, although not coun- terpoint in its literal meaning, it has been deemed proper to begin with the development of a single voice (XXXIV); then, as an adjunct, a few hints have been inserted in regard to accompaniment forms. Succeeding this will be found (XXXV) the contrapuntal treatment of two voices ; then three (XXXVT); four (XXXVII;; and more than four (XXXVIII). It has been considered most expedient to enter this field only so far as is comprehended under the term Simple Counterpoint. Wlien the demand in this country for works on Double Counter- pointy Canon, Fugue etc., shall warrant it, this department will very probably be enlarged by the remainder of Weitzman's very- original and valuable course of study in these higher branches. PAET IV. Composition. This brief division gives an esthetical and technical synopsis of the acknowledged Forms of Composition, together with hints upon the modulation or changes of key to be employed. In conclusion, conscious of having faithfully endeavored to dis- charge a pleasant duty toward my honored teacher, — to "whom I here record my lasting gratitude, — as well as towards my fellow- countrymen, I beg for the Author of the principles and practice set forth in these pages the justly deserved praise of the entire musical world, and for their Editor its most kindly and considerate reception. E. M. Bowman. St. Louis, 1876. PART I. CHAPTER I. MATERIAL OF MUSIC. The material of music is sound, and sound is produced when an elastic res- onant body is disturbed in such a manner as to cause that body to vibrate or oscillate rapidly, thus disturbing or oscillating the enveloping air, caus- ing what are termed air-waves, which, in their increasing circles, like the waves caused by casting a stone into the water, reach the tympanum of the ear, where this vibratory motion is caught up by the nerves of hearing and trans- mitted to the brain. If these vibrations follow each other, with mathematical regularity, the sound is musical; i. e., we can determine its pitch. Irregular vibrations produce simply noise. From the mass of tones varying in pitch, such a number have been adopted as the Tonal System as are easily distinguishable to the ear, and as are, at the same time, of practical precision in performance. In the earlier attempts at the formation of a Tonal System, only those tones were fixed upon as comprise what are now termed Natural tones; i. e., without flats or sharps, these being of later adoption. Thus, at first, the regular gradation of pitch or scale (from the latin and Italian word scala, signifying ladder) consisted of steps* and half-steps. * The words tone and semitone, often naed in the same sense, are an nnfortnnate designation, since tone can also refer, and more properly too, to hoih- pitch and quality of mnsical sonnd, ther^ fbre the eni j)loyment here of the terms step and haXf-step. 8 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. The propositioa before us in the study of music in general, is the considera- tion of musical sounds or tones as members of a language, a language which speaks from soul to soul only ; therefore, in order that a musical composition may be regarded as a work of art, it must possess an intelligible meaning as well as beauty of form. These essential characteristics are to be gained, in instrumental composi- tions, through the artistic use of Melody, Harmony and Rhythm, and in vo- cal, through the appropriate union of these elements with words. In the endeavor to reduce music to a written science, many and divers plans have been devised. It was remarked that the melodies of the people, or folk songs, especially those of the more civilized nations, moved in seven different principal tones, and that when this compass was exceeded the extra tones were but duplicates of some of the original seven, in a higher or lower pitch. -Thus, the entire Tonal System was at length divided into groups of seven tones each, a name or designation applied,and the same repeated through each group. By some nations, the first letters of the alphabet were applied, and by oth- ers, syllables. In accordance with other English text-books, the letters A, B, C, D, E, F, G, will be used in this work. Between these, so to speak, fundamental tones, others existed which grad- ually came into practical use, thus necessitating definite names in the written system. It was found most practical to consider these between-lying tones as eleva- tions or dejjressions in pitch of the fundamentals ; consequently, these added tones were indicated by the same letters, but were given certain additional signs to denote their difference. For example, if, instead of the original tone A, it was desired to indicate that tone lying next above; i. e., between A and B, this sign (jj), called a Sharp, was applied, and the tone received the name A Sharp. On the other hand, if that tone lying next below A was to be indicated, this sign (b), called a Flat, was applied, and the tone thus taken was called A Flat. The process was made use of in connection with all the other orig- inal tones. Later, other between-lying tones were added and were considered as double elevations or depressions of the originals, and to indicate the use of these a Double Sharp (x) or Double Flat (bb) was applied, and the tone thus taken was designated as A Double Sharp, ]} Double Flat, etc. To restore a tone, altered by any of these four methods, to its original name and sound, this sign (tJ), called a Natural, was applied. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 9 To indicate the relative acuteness or gravene.ss, in one word, the pitch of vlie various tones, a system of five lines with their four intervening spaces. ^: called a Staff, has come to be universally adopted, and upon these lines and in the spaces the signs of the tones are placed, thus representing or picturing to the eye, and thereby to the mind, the exact relative position or pitch of these tones. The staff contains nine tone-degrees, .each line and each space consti- tuting one such degree, all of which are numbered upward as seen in the above diagram (1). Should the tones be too high or too low to be written within the compass of the staff, temporary lines with their spaces, termed Leger lines and spaces, are used either above or below the staff, 3. and upon these added staff-degrees, the signs of sound may be placed to either extreme of pitch, there being no prescribed limit to their use. To determine the names of the various staff-degrees, it is necessary to fix upon some one of them as a starting-point. This point is indicated by a character called a Clef (signifying key), and as the employment of only one clef would necessitate the use of a great number of leger lines in order to accommodate ull the tones in the system," thus increasing the difficulty of reading music, it has been found ad- vantageous to use several different clefs, though ordinarily for voices and most instruments there are only two. 'These are the G clef, which determines the second line of the staff as G, ^•i- and the F clef, which fixes the fourth line of the staff as F. i.—F The name of the p'^int of departure having been determined, those of the other staff-degrees at once become easy, inasmuch as the regular course of the alphabet is followed, — forward in ascending, backward in descending, for ex.: 10 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. The F clef may also be so placed as to indicate the third line as F and th» other degrees accordingly, rftr.- r-fi-;; — etc. 60 also the G clef may be placed upon the first line, thus: 8. -e , -etc. — x: though this latter has become obsolete. The F clef upon the third line is al- so very rarely used. There is a third character, termed the C clef, of various forms (fl^ or fe or te etc.), which can be placed on either the first, second, third or fourth line, in each case determiuiug the name of the line upon which it rests as C, for ex. : — Formerly the C clef was invariably used for various kinds of voices. Thus, parts written for Sopranos used this clef upon the first line, as at 9, those for Mezzo Sopranos upon the second line (10), for Altos, upon the third (11), and for Tenors upon the fourth (12). Remark. — It should be understcx)d that either form of the C clef, above used, is equally suitable to these four varieties of voice. We have used them all simply to show their application to the staff. lu this mauaer composers were enabled to express the compass of the dif- ferent voices without the use of many logcr hues, but, owing to the complexity of so many diiferent systems, all except the G 'and F clefs have been practi- cally abandoned in vocal music; the G clef u})oii the second line being used for the Soprano, Alto and generally the Tenor, and the V clef upon the fourth hue for the Bass, and sometimes the Tenor. TONE SIGNS. Haviug learned that the staff is used ui)on which to place the signs of the tones, we come now to consider those signs. They are characters called Notes, wliich, by their po.siYic»?i, high or low, upon the staff, indicate the jj;7t.7( of the tones to be produced, and which, by their yb/Vii, determine the rclulive duration of those tones. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TUEOKY. ' These characters are as follows: — 11 13. 1 Whole note. HalfnoU. Quarter. Eighth. Sixteenth. Thirty-second. Sixty/ourVi. > C? 1 1 5 \ I Hemi-demi-semi- quaver. Semi-breve. ILinim. Crotchet. Qyuiwr. SemiqtMver. Demi-semi- quaver. The use of the designation, whole, half, etc., is recommended in preference to semi-breve etc., on account of its greater facility in making the relative val- ues understood. The Whole-note, in modern music, is regarded as the unit, occupying all of an allotted amount of time, while the Half, Quarter, etc., occupy the relative amount indicated by their names. In former times the Maxima ( W ) or Large ; the Longa ( H ) or Long, and the Brevis ( n ) or Breve were in vogue, then' value being respectively eight, four and two whole-notes. The first two are now obsolete, but the latter ( 1=1 ) is occasionally met with. The relative value of the notes will be seen from the following table : 14.. • I -f .t: .'0 '. .* ^ t^ 0'. 0\ 0. .*• 0''.O O e 09 ee9» 0090000 0000000000000000 000000000000000 000000000000000 ill S E The above table is so arranged in pyramids (see dotted lines, .•*•.), that a glance will be sufficient to learn the number of notes of any one kind which are equal to one of any other kind. The note at the apex of each pyramid is equal to either of the lines of notes underneath going to make up that pyramid. 12 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. b o -TS m "Th a ^ H* 'S' a o o 00 Oj <» d ^c: S^ bo O 5tt CO O a o o .tJ en ji, S 03 O bo !=1 s '« ■5 ^ O O) _ aj « a, ^ 2 <^ H a 44-U4UI ♦I-1-U4II «i4444J4 +444444 •^41144 ♦44444 44444 *4444 ^4 J ♦444 *^44 ♦44 <4 ♦4 4 ♦ IOC -3! 03 •a; w ui 4 li fl s; -^ md^ 0311 till VhII oil '^ll oil ^11 cell oil ,^11 ,c3ll tri.l =«|| oil '^11 Oil ^ I CJ I '^H I • o I iko I rw I l/ ■ \ ffil I I rrr» 111* ^ .3 o CD C3 o cs c 5 ^ O" - d p h; t> 03 r; « c3 S -S ^ 1:^ 03 -^J ^ ncTl O « ~ ffi ^ ^ o o OT CO I I ^ ^ o ^ c3 ^ « _- ^ " -=: « = o ■^ I g S « -S r=, ^ ^ o o il t> 2 a> O ■!> o ■5 -- a^ o li bD o - n3 o (-1 - , ;-! c! QJ ^ o ^ ^ n o o c3 'ce n3 O) ^ o O h 3 lit :=: a ■r. ll> CO p: ZJ o ttt* O -tJ o J_J ^ Ml> c3 o '^' rf Milt r* o o" llll> ^ t3 .2 g > +J a> c3 »— t >> H "73 irj a Oj o c3 o 3 "3 is MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 13 RESTS. SIGNS OF SILENCE. It being often desirable to suspend a sound for a greater or less length of time, signs of silence, called Rests, corresponding to the signs of sound or Notes, are employed. The following table exhibits the corresponding Notes and Rests: 16. ^ WhoU rest. Half. Quarter. Eighth. Sixteenth. Thirty-second. Sixty-fourth. ■-■ jm. 2 or ^ 1 ^ •< I a r r 5 \ The relative valuation of the various rests is the same, of course, as that of notes. Kemaek. — The mode of indicating a rest for any desired length of time will be given further along. PROLONGATION. TIE, DOT & PAUSE. There are three ways of indicating the prolongation of a tone ; viz., by- means of the Tie, Dot and Pause. I. The Tie is a curved line (- — -) placed over or under two notes represent- ing the same pitch, e. g., _»_«_: iZitui;^- and indicates the articulation of but one sound equal to their united lengths. Thus, a half and an eighth- note connected by a tie would be sung or played as one sound, equal to the duration of five eighth-notes, for ex.: — Tied notes. Value. A tie can join only two notes, therefore a greater number of notes require a tie to each two, as above. Further, as a rule, the second note of a tie should not be longer than the first, as that causes a disagreeable halting effect, except where there are other parts or voices which may be so treated as to counteract it. (This will be more (ully referred to at another place). II. The Dot (•) is placed after a note and signifies an increase iu the du» ration equal to one-half the value of that note. (See following table.) 18. Dotted notes. Values. • J. 1 4 ' A 1 r r 1/ t^ 5 ? ^ ^ r 14 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. Two or more dots may be used, each additional one adding one-half the value of the dot preceding it, for ex: — 19. r eta III. The Pause {^ or Hold is placed over or under a note thus: so. and signifies a continuation of the sound so long as the judgment of the per- former may dictate. DIMINUTION. TRIPLETS, &C. Any kind of a note may be divided' into three equal parts instead of two; into five, six or seven instead of four; into nine, ten or eleven instead of eight, and so on. Thus, instead of dividing a quarter-note into two eighths, it may be divided into three, producing thereby what is called a Triplet, for ex. : — 31. •1* Such groups are usually enclosed with a curved line and marked with the figure 3. So also, a quarter-note, ordinarily divided into four sixteenths, may be divided into five, six or seven sixteenths, so marked and called a Quintolet, Sextolet and Septolet respectively, thus: 33. J -^ A quarter note is equal to eight thirty-seconds; it may also be divided into nine, ten or eleven notes of the same denonaination, thus: 33 ! S=a S==S:^ 5W55B 090* 0000 "^ 000 0»0 000 °^ 00000S0eat fill '■f'W f!?- It is to bo understood that it is not the aggregate time of a quarter, or any other chosen note, which is diminished, but rather the component i)arts which are derived from such a note, for if three notes are performed in the same time as two; five, six or seven in the same time as four, it follows that the time of each derivative note is diminished ^wst in ratio to the increase in the number of notes derived. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBY. 16 MEASURES. In order to render musical compositions intelligible, as well as to facilitate their reading and performance, it has been found necessary to divide them into short sections of equal duration called measures. BARS. DOUBLE BARS. To the ear, measures are indicated by regularly recurring accents, and to the eye, they are separated by a perpendicular line across the staff called a Bar. At tlie end of a composition or movement the^-eof ; i. e., a complete musical sentence, a Double Bar is placed. Ex.: — 34. H Bar. Bar. Double bar. P METER. METRICAL DIVISIONS. TIME. Measures are in their turn sub-divided into two, three, four or more equal parts, and the regular succession of these parts is called in music Me- ter. The parts themselves are denominated Metrical Divisions, and this meas- uring of sounds by means of measures, metrical divisions and notes is called Time. To indicate the number of metrical divisions which shall appear in a measure, and also the vahie of each division, two figures, in the form of a frac- tion, arc placed at the beginning of the piece or movement. The upper fig- ure, or numerator, denotes the number of pai'ts'm each measure, and the low- er, or denominator, the value of each of those parts, by indicating into how many parts the unit of time (a whole-note) has been divided. Ex.: — a. 6. t d. e. 3.5. -Hr-^ _i2^ :to= <^ " -^-^—r- zk-eiL » ~~» — -.^Z^=M=^=^ -^1= — i — 1 1 — 1 -4-^ i — :-^q= -1— -4— ' L—^ ; \ V-\ Ef? T=t: ii H 1 r- At a of Ex. 25, the numerator (2) shows that tliere are two parts or met- rical divisions in each measure, and the denominator (2), showing tlie value. of those divisions, denotes that the unit of time has been divided into two 16 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. parts; t.e., into half-notes; therefore, where the figures are % each measure must contain two half-notes or their equivalent. At 6, the letter ^ with a stroke through it indicates the same thing. At c, there are two quarter-notes in each measure ; at d, four quarter-notes, and at e the same thing, and so on. We shall recur to this subject further along. RHYTHM. It will be remembered that the metrical divisions of a measure follow each other with mathematical regularity. It is not necessary, however, or advisa- ble, that the succession of sounds shall always follow the meter, as that would be very monotonous, but, one sound may continue through several metrical parts, or several sounds may be given out during one such part, or rests of any length may occur. This diversified manner of filling out the meter is called Rhythm. To illus- trate this, we will take a series of notes in which the Rhythm and Meter move together, (see Ex. 26). Let the lines above the staff indicate the metrical succession in each of the three following examples. 36. I I I I I I III E: I I ±=X ;^ -■fcsEE^Eg ^ I I I I I I I I I II ---^^qzit — I I I I I I -»—^ m 2S. ^ — J. ^ *^ -—\ :t5= d^ -J«— I I tf-.H- • s — c*-«* Exs. 21 and 28 show the identical sounds used in Ex. 26 arranged in such a manner as to present some rhythmical divisions longer and some shorter than the metrical divisions. The character of the passage is quite different in each example, thus evidencing the wonderfully varied effect obtainable from a judi- cious use of this accessory of musical art. TEMPO. Of themselves notes have only a relative duration, therefore something more is necessary in order to fix the standard of time. The words Grave, Largo, Lento, Lar ghetto, Adagio, Andante, Andantino, Allegretto, Allegro, Vivace, Presto and Prestissimo, represent the dozen principle degrees of movement from the slowest to the fastest. Each of these arc often niodifi(>d by other additional words, as for ex.> — Allegro, ma non troppo, (Fast, but not too fast), etc. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. JY Even the above words are not an absolute indication of the temjjo or time, bnt they approximate it. Thus, a movement in quarter-notes, marked Grave, would be performed very slowly; marked Andante, neither slow nor fast; but marked Prestissimo, these same quarter-notes would be executed as fast as possible. The relative values of notes always remain the same, but the absolute values change with every change in the tempo. The Metronome, invented by Mael- zel, indicates the tempo with mathematical exactness, and it is to be regretted that it is not more generally used. A general idea of the above terms will be gained by referring to this instrument. DYNAMICS. WORDS AND MARKS OF EXPRESSION. That which appertains to poxver and quality of tone belongs under the head of Dynamics. The five principal degrees of power are represented by the words pianissimo (as soft as possible), piano (soft), mezzo (medium), forte (loud), fortissimo (as loud as possible). The words piano and forte are modified by the combination mezzo-piano (medium soft) and mezzoforte (medium loud)» and all are abbreviated as follows: pp, p, mp, ni, mf f ff. ■ A tone has also fire principal niodes of expression, called and indicated as follows: 1. The organ tone, indicated thus: nz: which has the same degree of power from beginning to end. 2. The crescendo, thus: — =:, commencing softly and increasing at will. 3. The diminuendo, thus: :=— , the opposite of crescendo. 4. The swell, thus: —=::>—, a union of ci'es. and dim.. 5. The .forzando, thus: A or <, or >, or abbreviated sfz.fz, etc.; an explosive sound followed by an instantaneous diminuendo. Various other signs and words are used to indicate the manner of expres- sion, a few of which are here given: Legato; smooth and connected; also indicated by enclosing the notes with a curved line, (- — ■) called a slur. Staccato; short or detached; also indicated by points (""), dots (***•), or a combination of dots and the slur (•"^O (placed over or under the notes) thus giving three degrees of staccato. Accelerando; a gradual acceleration of the tempo. Rallentando; a gradual slackening of the tempo. A piacere or ad libitum; the tempo at pleasure. Sostenuto or tenuto; sustained. Scherzando; sportive. Dolce; sweetly. Maestoso; majestically etc., etc. 18 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. ABBREVIATIONS, &C. Divers devices to economize space and time are often made use of. Thus, wiien the same sound is to be repeated several times in a measure, one note equal to all of them may be so written as to express this repetition, for ex. : — 'WrMcTi. Performed. Writtmx. Performed. 39. 30.] As seen in Ex. 29, if the same sound be desired eight times, each of the value of an eighth note, they may be indicated by a whole-note accompanied by one stroke; if sixteen sixteenths are desii*ed, then by a whole-note and two strokes. Ex. 30. shows the method of expressing six eighth-notes (a), four six- teenths {IS) and two sixteenths (c). The Tremolo, a more or less rapid alternation of two tones or a group of two parts, may be abbreviated after the same principle. Ex: 31. e-a> * * * I* e c tf 1 Further, the repetition of a group of notes may be expressed by a single Btroke (Ex. 32. a) if in eighth-notes, by two strokes if sixteenths (Ex. 32. b) and the repetition of an entire measure, when the notes are of equal value, may be signified by one, two or more strokes according as the notes are eighth, sixteenth, etc. (Ex. 32. (c). Writhfn. Pa formed. WntUn. Performed. ^_ -r-n Egg gg gg Ci — \-0 0-rz — I — H* — \-0 0-h^-0 [—0 a A Perforined. -0-^9- :?SS^3 To indicate the repetition of one or more measures in wliich notes of dif- ferent values have been used, the passage is enclosed with a curved line or brackets and marked 6i.s ("again"). Ex.: — Tem/po di Marcia. 33. MAM'AL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 19 When an entire musical period is to be repeated, dots are placed at the double-bars. If placed before the double bar, thus: 3tb ^^ signifies the re- petition of the preceding period; if after, thus: djl— . then the period fol- lowing. This character (^) with the words al segno (" to the sign") indicates a rep- etition "commencing back where the (jf!) was last placed, and, finally, Da Capo or D. G. signifies a repetition from the beginning, in which case the final close is generally marked with the word Fine, or a pause over a double bar, thus: Where a rest of several measures is to be observed, it is indicated by a stroke across the staff and the number of measures of silence desh'ed, for ex. : — 90. 34=. Rests for one, two, three and four measures, no matter in what time the composition may be written, are often expressed as follows: (1) (2) (3) (4) 33. ztit: 8-- = B=E The whole-rest is used here in the sense of a whole-measure rest and not in the sense of its equality with a whole-note. • INTERVALS.' The difference of pitch between two sounds is termed an Interval. To the ear, the compass of an interval is determined by the relative graveness and acuteness of the two sounds, and to the eye by the space occupied upon the staff. The designation of an interval is determined by the number of staff- degrees embraced. Thus, two sounds expressed on the same staff-degree form an interval termed a Prime. No. 36 exhibits several different sounding inter- vals, but as all are expressed upon the same staff-degree, they are all primes. (Unison)* Primes. 3G. * Remark. — An miison or prime of one and the same sound, is only a theoretical interral. .lince in order to fulfil the conditions of a real or practical inter%'al, there must be a difference of piieli. We would rt'uiaik here also, that in tcachiujr the present subject it has been the author' .s c istoni to introduce at first only intervals in general, reserviu'.: the subject of sjvci/fc interv:'ls until fheir derivations are thoroughly understood. These will therefore bo developed iu detail a few pages further oa. 20 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. An interval occupying two staff-degrees is called a Second, no matter wliat changes in the sound are made by the application of sharps or flats. Ex. : — Seconds. 37.^^^- -t:^^ ^|g: jg^ [|2gg :j^ iblzgg J2^g: ilzgjig : :b2s|g -Ws^^\ A Third occupies three staff-degrees; a fourth, four; a Fifth, five, and so on. We append examples: — Thirds. 38. Fourths. Fifths. Boj^l^j^i Sixths. ? 1 ^ '^ 1 tf *^' m Sevenths. 4=0.^1: la: ,fe Eighths or Octaves. -i9- -6f>- feg^ ^iS Ninth. Tenth. Eleventh. Twelfth. Thirteenth. Fourteenth. Fifteenth. jZ. jSL 4=1 9= ^=^=:^^ Second. Third. Fourth. Fifth. Sixth. Seventh. Eighth. Intervals, as a rule, are counted from the lower tone upward. When counted downward, it should be so specified, for ex.: a fifth, sixth, etc., "be- low." Also, for the sake of greater simplicity, intervals greater than an oc- tave are reckoned as seconds, thirds, etc. Two methods of practice should follow here, in order to ensure a thorough comprehension of the subject thus far. 1st. Let the pupil be required to name the various general intervals from a given letter. 2nd. Require the pupil to name the interval between any two given letters. MELODY. A succession of tones rhythmically ordered, possessing an intelligible mean- ing and moving themselves around a chief-tone is termed a Melody. By chief- tone is to 1)e understood that tone, upon wliieh a melody can close, producing a Bcnse of perfect rest. A melody may be rendered by one or more voices or instruments in unison or in octaves. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 21 MOTIVE. FIGURE. A Motive or Figure is a group of two or more notes from which may be constructed passages of different kinds. A few of the multitudinous modes of elab- orating a motive are shown in the following examples. Careful study and practice upon original motives are earnestly recommended, as readiness in this direction enables the composer not only to be economical with his ideas, but also to secure unity in his compositions. \st. Taking the following group as a motive: — 4=3. -f— #— f a passage may be formed by its simple repetition, thus: — 4:3. ^# • — "<* etc. 'ind. The motive repeated on other degrees higher or lower, thus: — 44. 2 2 ^ m " 1 — ■ — I ' I — I I I -—: — I I i — I — — -— 1 ^-#-^-sH ,*H 0-\ 1 \ ^c___l |-^«-«-»-#-,-«-H-W-T-»— i— 1-f^-l— 1« , \ 1 1 P-'mmmmi^^^.^^m^ ——3 \ — * «^~a^-^»-^0-^ -\ Srd. The motive repeated in more distant positions, thus:- -0s-»- 45. ^f^— f-*-r (5 P-»- f ^ — ,» ! 0-^-0 — 1^ 1 1 ^-f- f-p-i— ^- ^—?— — - k^M o, W ^—1- mmm^wmmi HBaiB^ '-^*m3 -0 - ^— #— ^-^=- =iZ=t=rf ith. Reversing the direction of the intervals in the original motive, thus: Original. 46. and repeating as in Ex. 43, 44 or 45, etc. bth. Alternate use of the original and contrary motion, thus: — 6//i. By augmenting or diminishing the value of the notes, thus: — 48 ■fei^ '— ","^^*^«**^*'^-''^^'**- 22 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THUOBT. 1th. Free; i. e. usiug different intervals from those in tlie original motive, for ex.: — Slh. Partial abandonment of the melodic character of the motive, thus: — 9th. Total abandonment of the melodic character, but retention of the rhythm : — i? ^ ^ ^ 51. Ai^-^-/»-^-^-:^-SS-:::- - ^ fi ^^ % ^ :^ It is hardly neccessary to add that the above is a mere suggestion of the possibilities of invention. HARMONY. CHORD. The scientific union of two or more different sounds is termed Harmonj One such combination is called a Chord. Ex. : — 52.p CONSONANCE. The union of two or more tones possessing in itself the quality of indppencf- ence or sense of rest, is termed a Consonance. Ex. : — 5 3. DISSONANCE. The combination of two or more tones which produces the effect ol depend ence, a sense of unrest, a striving toward vest, IstermedaDissonanc* Ex.: — 54= RESOLUTION. The progression, according to established rules, of a dissonance ir-co a cot»- sonancc, is termed a Resolution. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 23 DECEPTIVE CADENCE. The progression of oue dissouauce to another instead of the expected reso- lution into a consonance, is termed a Deceptive Cadence. SCIENCE OF HARMONY. This branch of music treats of the construction, entrance and progression of chords according to established rules. SCIENCE OF METRICS. This branch treats of the construction of different kinds of rhythm, and the symmetrical joining of musical sections, phrases and periods. Also of the ac- cented and unaccented parts of measures and the correct method of placing chords with regard to accents. . SCIENCE OF COUNTERPOINT. This treats of the construction of two or more i?J6?epe?7C?<'?i^ melodies, which, though heard at the same time, do not transgress the laAvs of Harmony. In Counterpoint the different melodies may be begun together, or they can follow each other in imitative style, and then move on together, as for ex. in Canons and Fuffues. CHAPTER II. THE THEORETIC ESTABLISHMENT OF THE TONE-SYSTEM. We have already rehearsed the practical development of our tone-system, and as it is decidedly appropriate in a work on theory that the conf.rmation or reason-why of that which is practical shall also be given, that confirmation will be in order here. The tone-system, as we have seen, is that series of tones which form the base and material of musical composition. A string stretched over bridges, if vibrated and shortened little by little by approaching the bridges nearer to each other, will produce an almost indefinite number of differently pitched tones. There would be too many and too little difference in their pitch for practical use, if all were adopted; therefore, the proposition is to select such a series from this mass as have a practical variety of pitch, and at the same time are related, thereby capable of being formed into scientific melodies and harmonies. 24 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. To test this relation among the tones, the following simple experiments ^111 be sufficient. It is £f well-known fact that vibrating bodies vibrate not only fro'^a cud to end, but also simultaneously from half to half, third to third and so on; i. e., a body divides or bridges itself at these equi-distant points. It will be, readi- ly understood therefore, that a string, in dividing itself into so and so many parts, will give forth an equal number of tones at one and the same time, all of them differing in pitch, and all relatively audible in proportion to the vigor of their vibration, though all these sub-tones or Harmonics, as they are termed, will be vei-y soft in comparison with the tone given out by the entire string. If the entire string gives forth, for example the "great-octave F" (see dia- gram). F. a bridge placed at the exact centre will cause each half of the string to give F also, but an octave higher ; i. e., the " the small octave f." f. f. Again, if bridges are so placed as to divide the string into thirds, each third will produce the fifth higher; i. e., the "once-marked c.» Two-thirds of the string will give the octave lower; i. e., the "small-octave c," a fifth from the F produced by the whole string. Now, in attempting to develope a tonal-system, the relation or interval be- tween two certain tones must be adopted and perpetuated throughout the en- tire system, in order to secure relationship among all its members. There can be no more intimate relationship than that existing between a fundamental tone and its harmonics. The first hariponic, in order of power, is the octave of the fundamental, but a perpetuation of that relation would nev- er yield a tone varying in pitch from the fundamental, except at octaves MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 26 The uext harmonic most audible, is the fifth of tlie fundamental. The per- petuation of this relation continually yields new tones. This was the relation, a consonant fifth, so called because of its inherent quality of independence, used in the establishment of our system, therefore the first tone added to the starting-point (F) was C; the next added was the fifth of C, G; then the fifth of G-, D; and so on, as per following series: — F, C, G, D, A, E, B. Thus, each tone in its turn was first derived and then became a derivation, thereby securing the chain of relationship binding the whole system. TONIC. Each letter, except B (the reason of which will be given directly) was taken as the initial of a series, and the alphabetical order of the remaining letters constituted the group or family which acknowledged this as their chief-tone, or as it was termed, the Tonic. THE GREEK OR ECCLESIASTICAL SCALES. These -various scr'es, distinguished by fixed names, formed the Greek or Ec- clesiastical Scales, their individuality consisting in the different order of the intervals or steps and half-steps composing them. All but the Ionian and ^-Eolian have been abandoned in modern music, but we append them all, directing attention to the order of their intervals. Geebk oe Ecclesiastical Scales. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8. Lydian, F, g, a, b, c, d, e, f. Ionian. C, d, e, f, g, a, b, c. Mixo-Lydian. G, a, b, c, d, e, f, g. Dorian. D, e, f, g, a, b, c, d. JSolian. A, b, c, d, e, f, g, a. Phrygian. E, f, g, a, b, c, d, e. SUB-DOMINANT. DOMINANT. As stated above, the first tone of each series or scale was called the Tonic; it is the tone, around which, the others revolve; it is, so to speak, the centre, from which they radiate, and towards which they gravitate. Nearest 26 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. related to the tonic, is that tone from which it sprung Cits fifth below), and that tone which in turn s]5rung from it (its fifth above). These related tones ■were called Dominants, so named on account of their dominating or controlling influence in determining the tonic. The first was called the Sub-Dominant, and the Inst the Dominant. The dominating influence of the latter, it must be remarked, is greater than that of the former. If C, for ex., be regarded as the tonic, then F is its sub-dominant, and Gr its dominant; if A is the tonic, then D is the sub-dominant, and B the dominant. It being essential that the dominant shall always be the consonant fifth of the tonic, here will appear the reason for not using the letter B as the tonic for an Ecclesiastical Scale. Ad alphabetical series commencing with that letter would be as follows: B, c, d, e, f, g, a, b. and, as will be seen, the fifth (F) is not a consonance with the B, therefore, a: the scale had no Dominant, the letter B could not be established as a Tonic. EXTENSION OF THE TONE-SYSTEM. Parallel to the want of a Dominant in the series commeucing upon B, though by no means so serious a matter, the Lydian Scale, whose Tonic was F, lacked a sub-dominant. These needs wei'e supplied in the progress of time by the addi- tion of new tones to the system, by means of pei'petuating the same relatioD as that existing between the others. Thus, the consonant fifth below Y,viz: B!7,was adopted, supplying a Sub-dominant to the Lydian Scale; then, Fj| was added to the other end of the system, furnishing a Dominant to B. The ex- tension was carried forward until at length the system with its adopted tones stood as follows: — ab, eb, bb, F, C, G, D, A, E, B, f J, cj, gj^. Here it remained for a time, but as the ab and g|^ came so near being an octave, it excited a discussion among the theorists which resulted in the addi. ti-on of other tones in the endeavor to find an interval wliich Avould fulfil the conditions of a perfect octave. The system was extended as far as the fol- lowing series indicates: — fi?, cb, '^, db, ab, eb, bb, F, C, G, D, A, E, B, f jf, cjf, g#, dj. a#, ejj, bjf. and no perfect octave appeared. Then, each letter was double-sharped and double-flatted, as follows: — fbb, ebb, gbb, dbb, abb, ebb, bbb; fb, cb, gb, db, ab, cb, bb; F, c, G, D, A, E, B; fjj, ej(, oJ_ d|, a#, ej(, bjf; fx, ex, gx, dx, ax, ex, bx. resulting finally in the declaration that the octave relation would never appear though tones were added ad infinitum. The system was ailirraed to be one MANUAL OF MUSICAl THEORY 27 without end, and, on account of being composed of consonanl oi pure fifths was designated the Pure System. EVEN TEMPERAMENT. Certain other more progressive theorists, however, regarding this mass of tones, infinite in number, as unpractical, advocated forcing an octave between the Ab and Gjif alluded to, by means of tempering or tuning the fifth a shade smaller. Thus, by flatting each fifth throughout the system a very slight degree, the Al? and G^ were brought into the relation of a perfect octave, thereby estab- lishing a boundary, reducing the infinite number to twelve tones in the com- pass of an octave and fixing a system of more practical use in both Melody and Harmony. This was called the Even Temperament. The strife among the theorists as to which is best has continued down to the present day, but as nearly all of the greatest masters, Bach, Haydn, Mozart, Beethoven and others, adopted and used the Even Temperament, besides the fact that all keyed instruments aye adapted thereto, the strife seems to be one sided. Weitzraann's illustra- tion is terse and pertinent, — " Gold is of little utility before being tempered; just so, fifths need tempering, in order to prepare them for practical use." SPECIFIC INTERVALS. Specific intervals are measured by steps and half-steps, and, for the sake of still greater distinctness, there are two kinds of half-step. If the half-step is expressed upon the same staff-degree, as at a, ex. 55, it is called a small or chromatic half-step; if it is expressed upon contiguous degrees, as at b, ex. 55, it is then called a great or diatonic half-step. a. Chromatic or sTnall. 5. Diatonic or great. 55. I W- Half-step. Half-step. Thus far, we have presented only intervals in general. We have Icarned.for example, that tones occupying two contiguous stafF-degrees always fonu sec- onds, no matter what variations in the sound may be effected through the use of sharps and flats. To distingui.'h these variations, one from the other, a Rpecial name for each is nescessary 28 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. CLASSIFICATION OF INTERVALS. Intervals are divided into four general classes, as follows: — I. Major. II. Minor; a small half-step smaller than major. III. Diminished; a small half-step smaller than minor. IV. Augmented; a small half-step greater than major. Remabk. — In modern compositions, intervals smaller than diminished, and gpeatei than augmented sometimes occur. Such are called double-diminished or double-augmen- ted, and frequently require the use of even a /ripZe-flat or triple-sharp. Although rare- ly used, these are as logically correct as the double-&it or double-sharp. It will be seen from the above definitions that major intervals are taken aa the basis from which to determine the others, therefore the first effort should OP towards fixing the basis thoroughly in mind. DETERMINATION OF MAJOR INTERVALS. A Major Prime is one and the same tone. A Major Second is one whole step. A Major Third is two whole steps. A Major Fourth is three whole steps. A Major Fifth. — The fifths have already been learned in the establishment of the tonal system. bl7 > # f, c, g, d, a, e, b, f, c, g, d, a, e, b, F, C, G, D, A, E, B, f, c, g, d, a, e, b. f, c, g, d, a, e, b. A Major Sixth is a major fifth and one whole step. A Major Seventh is a major fifth and two whole steps. The Major Octave, Major Ninth, etc., are regarded the same as a Major Prime, Major Second, etc. Table of majob niTEBVAia fbom F. Majoe. Prime. Second. Third. Fourth. Fifth. Sixth. Seventh. f Octave.) 50. ^z - ^ 7 7-^—^: ZSL -DO C^ ^ 23 IS ^ "Z? -Gf- -IS- The following exercise is here recommended. Let the pupil be required to name and write all the major intervals from the various letters, until consid- erable readiness is acquired. I ^ MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOllT. 29 MINOR INTERVALS. As already defined, they are a small half-siep smaller than major mteJ*vjtl8 Ex.:— Major. Minor. Major. Minor. sr .9^ is: zzk 2? — Fourth. Third. Third. Table of minor intervals from F. Minor. Second. Third. Fourth. Fifth. Sixth. Seventh. 58 .9= 9 fourth, as seen at b. If the upper tone, at c, be placed below the original lower one, as at d, the same relation results except that the position is an octave lower. We give here a few general ex- amples of inversion: 5 Original Inversion. Orig. Inv. etc. Fosition. ^jy^ . -ig- «4. Second. Ith. Third. Gth. Fourth. 5th. Fifth. 4th. Sixth. 3d. Seventh. As the thorough comprehension of this subject will greatly facilitate the comprehension of the entire subject of music, the following rules and exami)les are recommended to careful study and exercise in various keys, both oral and written: — RULES. I. The inversion of all major interval.^ produces miiior. Kemaek. — Major intervals will be indicated by Roman, and minor by Arabic nota- tion. Diminished intervals will be indicated by placing the bign ( o ) at the right of the figure, thus: 7', and aufjment?d hy this sign (>), thus: G*. Table of major intekvals it.om F wixn their inversion'.^!. e5.9-==^^ -US'- in SE'^Efeb*^ IV 'ITS' Y VI .■^ -»^ ^0Z3 VII MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOllY. ol II. The inversion of minor inlervah produces major. Table of minor inteevaxs fkom F with their inversions. ^^^^5=^3 2 Vn 3 VI 4 V 5 IV 6 in 7 II III. The inversion of diminished intervals produces augmented. Table. ^§?^^^S^^ 4= 5V 5° 4V 6= 3* 7= 2>' IV. The inversion of augmented intervals produces diminished. Table. es, To render au interval capable of inversion, there must be a lower and up- per tone to start with. It follows therefore that the prime cannot be inverted. In some text-books the following examples are given as inversions. 60.| Inversion of primes. Q) octai^es. "Z?iL :»s: I ^^ vni I vm vni i vin i These are instances of transposition (Gr: versetzung, change of position) of one voice an octave higher or lower, while inversion (umhehrung) means to turn upside down. It will readily be seen that altering the position of any- thing standing upon a plane, as does a prime, or causing anything to assume the position of a plane, is not inversion but transposition. Those who are familiar A\nth the presentation of intervals and their inver- sions in other works on the Theory of Music, will doubtless recognize a dif- ference in the present one. Heretofore, in all the text-books which have come under the e^'es of the author or the editor of this work, intervals have been divided into the following five classes, viz: Perfect, Major, Elinor, Diminished and Augmented. In this system, the use of the term Perfect has been dis- carded, and all the intervals so classed that they are either Major, Minor, Di- minished or Augmented. We deem an explanation of this new departure and its advantages apropos. The adjective perfect, means something that is perfect, or else it conveys no meaning whatever. It follows naturally that to speak of a perfect fourtli and a perfect fifth, in the present prevailing use of the Even Temperar ment, is a contradiction in itself because both of those intervals are tempered, i. €., they are not perfect. 32 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TJlEOIiT. The only intervals which may be properly retaiiieJ as perfect, are the prime and octave, but as the word Majur can qualify those intervals with equal pro- priety and distinctness, we have adopted its use, and have thereby been en- abled to cast aside one superfluous term, thus reducing the number of classes from five to four, and making a step towards the simplification and systemiza- tion of an abstruse subject. This, according to o;ir conception of a text-book, will recommend itself to any unprejudiced, progres.-iive mind. The advantages claimed for the system of intervals as presented in this text-book are as fol- lows: 1. One certain interval (the major') may always be taken as the starting- point from which to determine the minor, diminished and augmented; therefore, knowing the major, we can easily determine the augmented, as it is a half-step ' greater, or the minor, as it is a half-step smaller, or the diminished, as it is a balf-step smaller still. With the use of "perfect" intervals, this systematic order is not obtainable (compare the following tables). Perfect PK1ME8. Secokds. Tinuns. FOUllTHS. FliTlIS Skventiis OCTAVKS 70. Maj. Min. Dim. Aug. Jlnj. 71. Min. Dim. Aug. • Note See » xplanntioii on page 34 MA y UAL OF MUSICAL THEOMY. 33 Comracncinji- witli thirdi^, there is a marked difference throughout the two tables, more especially in ihc diminished intervals, and, as will be remarked, the second table (11), the one set forth by this system, discards tb°, class of *' perfect'' intervals entirely. 2. As will be readily seen, greater system and regularity, therefore greater simplicity, is secured by the method exhibited in Example 71, and further, one serious error is disposed of, an error which lias long been a cause of perplexity and confusion to the student of musical theory. We allude to the way of teaching diminished intervals. No. 70 professes to give the various intervals taking the tone C as a starting-point, and, as will be noticed, the diminished inter- vals are so made by raising the lower tone, whereas in the second table, No. 71, the upper tone, instead, is depressed. If a pupil were asked to name the letter forming a diminished third from Cfc, would it be reasonable for him to answer, "Cjt and Elz?" (compare above tables on that interval). The diminished third of Ct} is obviously Ebb, and EpisthcdiniinishcdlhirdofCjJ as a starting-point. It is stated that this rais- ing of the lower tone comes of itself, through the relations developed in in- versions; viz: the inversion of augmented interYnh produces diminished. (It is quite as correct to say that augmented intervals are produced through the in- version of diminished; therefore the origin of each is equally dependent upon the other). To prove that in order to diminish an interval, it is correct to raise the lower tone, the auirmented fifth is used, or rather misused, in the follow- ing-wise. It is said that if F and Cjif, an augmented fifth, be inverted, the diminished fourth, CJI and F, results, as follows: ^ g?' ■ I 5v 4° Hence, the elevation of the lower tone comes of itself. The deduction is therefore, that the diminished fourth of Cfc} is Cjj^ and F. Is it any Avonder that confusion follows ? If we are compelled to seek the origin of the diminished fourth of Cin an augmented fifih, would it not be quite as reasonable to use the tone;-} Fb and Ct}, which certainly form just as correct an augmented fifth as Th and C^? By inverting Fb and Ct] we shall discover that the diminished fourth is formed by depressing the upper tone of a minor fourth, thus: "^ 5V 4° The relation produced, that of a diminished fourth, abstractly considered is of course the same, whetlier the lower tone is raised or the upper tone loAvered but, considered in connection with C^, Fjz is clearly its diminished fourth, while 34 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Ft} is the diminished fourth of C^, therefore belonging to quite another Toaic. It will be seen in the table, Ex. 11, that all the diminished intervals are formed from the minor in the same way (the octave excepted, of which we shall speak presently) i. e., by lowering the upper tone. Again, in connection with fourths, if we reason a little farther we shall see that if C and Fb, thus:— ^ 42s: form a diminished fourth, then the minor- fourth, which is only a half-step greater, must be C and FJj, thus: * and not a major or perfect-fourth, as according to other text-books. Again, if C and F form a minor-fourth, then the ■mq;'o?*-fourth, which is a luilf-step greater than the minor, must be C and FjJ, thus: So also the augmented fourth, a half-step greater still, must be C and Fx, thus: — ^sz— £zj We have given the fourths in the table according to the above sequence. Passing on to fifths, we remark that if C and G form a major fifth, then the minor fifth, a half-step smaller, must be and G[7, (compare tables on this interval). If C and Gj? form a minor fifth, then C and GW, a half-step still smaller, must be the diminished fifth, and C and Gjji, a half-step greater than the major, the augmented fifth. The prime and octave are essentially the same thing, but as lowering the npper tone of an octave a half-step (a, Ex. 14), or raising the loAver a half-step (6) creates an interval to which the term prime cannot be properly applied, it becomes necessary to provide for this, so to speak, irregularity. a. b. 74:. If we invert the major octave, as for example: "5?: the relation is in no wise altered. It therefore follows that, as tin." inversion of major intervals produces minor, and vice ver.' 1? ^> '^i ^* 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1. A scale, therefore, is the degree-wise succession of the tones of any certain defined mode or key. DIATONIC SCALE. By this terra, is to be understood, a scale moving itself in the stem-tonf.'^ of a mode, presenting no smaller intervals than minor seconds, and none greater than major seconds. LEADING TONE. This member of our tone-system lies a great half-step below the Tonic. Thus, in the mode of C major, the leading-tone is B. The character of the leading- tone is a striving towards farther progression; hence its name. CHROMATIC. All those which are not strictly stem-tones in a mode, are said to be e/tro- matic. Ex. (see cross, x): — 7S. The Dji, F|ji and A\l in the above example are, in the key of G, chromatic^ CHROMATIC SCALE. A passage composed entirely of half-stops, is generally termed a chromatic scale. Ex.:— ENHARMONIC. (EQUIVOCAL.) Such tones, according to the Even Tempered System, as occupy different staff-degrees, thus bearing dilferent names, yet sound tlie same, are termed En- harmonic Toiics, for ex.: — q: — --\ — 1- 1 I iU =l?i --^^ etc MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. QQ RESUME OF THE TRIADS DEVELOPED IN A MAJOR MODE. Tluve major trhuLs, viz : upon tlic Tonic, Sub-dominant and Dominant. Three minor triads, viz : upon the tones related in the third and upon tke second degree of the scale. Two diminished triads, one upon the leading-tone, and one upon the second degree of the scale in the milder major mode. One augmented triad upon the third of the minor Sub-dominant triad. RESUME OF THE RELATIONSHIPS PRESENTED IN THE ABOVE TRIADS. Major triads consist of a fundamental, its majo)' third and major fifth. Minor triads consist of a fundamental, its minor third and major fifth. Diminished triads consist of & fundamental, its minor third andminor fifth. Augmented triads consist of a. fundamental, its major third and auqmented fifth. Remark. — The above are the only specific names given to triads, but many other siiiiiLir combinations are possible, as will be seen further on, to which the general name of Altered Accords, is given. There are, however, as we have already stated, only two consonant accords (major and minor triads); all others whatsoever bein" dissonant. CHAPTER V. THE SIGNATURE, ITS ORIGIN AND OFFICE. NORMAL MODE. The mode of C major is regarded as the Normal Mode. All other majoi modes are constructed according to the relationship set forth in that; i. p., there must be three major triads, based respectively upon any tone chosen ar^f. 40 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Ascending: F, g, a Descending : F, e, d 8, 1, 6, e, F. g, F. 2, 1.* The Dominant of F is C, a major fifth ahoue, or a minor fourth bdow the Tonic. A major triad upon C will be as follows: — C, e, g. Now if we unite these triads in their proper position, the scheme will pre- sent the tones forming the mode of F majoi', thus: — Sub-dom. triad. Tonic-triad. Dom. triad. SCALE OF F MAJOR. If these tones be now arranged degree-wise, or in alphabetical order, com- mencing with the Tonic, the result will be the Scale of F Major. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 1, 8. bb, c, d, c, bb, a, 5, 4, 3, . The introduction of the first flat (Bi?) occurs then, by forming a major mode upon F, as the Tonic. The relationships of the new mode will be found to exactly correspond with those of the normal mode (C major). The comparison may be made between the triads of the two modes or between their scales. In the first method, major triads will be found upon the Tonic, Sub-domin- ant and Dominant, and in the last, the steps and half-steps will be found to occur between the same numbers of the scale. SIGNATURE. So long as a composition or movement remains in the key of F major, the relationships of that mode must be maintained. For the sake of convenience, tne altered tone (B7) is indicated at the beginning of a composition or move- ment, by placing a flat (t?) upon that degree of the staff which bears the name of the tone to be altered. This sign is called a Signature, and, in the present case, would be written as follows: — 81. m BRACE. The Brace H) is a character used to unite or indicate the several staves which are to be played or sung together. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TIIEOIiY. 41 ACCIDENTALS. Tlie influence of the signature continues throughout the composition, unlesa contradicted liy the use of accidentals, or by a change of signature, Tluis, if the signature consists of one flat, or according to coinnion usage, if the signa- ture "is one fiat," the letter 13 is to be flatted every time it occurs, maless con- tradicted, no matter what its position upon the stafT may be, high or low. Accidentals are characters (^J, x, b- \'\^, tf). used either to cancel all or any part of the signature, or to alter any other of the stem-tones of a mode. They occur in a composition, so to speak, accidentally; i. e., with no defined regularity; hence the name. They are placed immediately before the note to be altered, and their influence continues to the end of the measure in which thej occur, unless sooner countermanded. From the beginning of the follow- ing measure, the signature again obtains effect. An accidental affects only that staff-degree upon which it is placed, therefore the octaves above or below also require the same sign. Kemaek. — These signs are all devised for distinctness and convenience to the exec- ativut, and, as there is never danger of excess iu these particulars, there would be nothing incorrect in countermanding an accidental even in after-measures, should the composer deem a do iH possible. MODE OF G MAJOR. If we take the other nearest related tone to C, viz: G, as Tonic, the Ton- ic-triad will be — ccTr^d. The Sub-dominant and Dominant of Gr are C and D, and, constructing ma- jor triads upon these tones in addition to the Tonic-triad, we shall have the stem-tones of the mode of G major, thus: — Sub-dom. -triad. Tonic-triad. Dom.-triad. SCALE OF G MAJOR. Arranging these alphal^etically, commencing with the Tonic, the result will be the scale of G major, thus: — 1, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8. Ascending : — Gr, a, b. c, d, e, 1% G. Descending : — Ct, » e, d, c, b, h G. 8, ^. 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1. The introduction of the first sharp (f |i) occurs therefore, in forming a major mode with G as the Tonic, and a composition or movement in the key of G major will require a signature of one sharp, that character being placed upon 42 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. the fifth line where the G clef is used, and upon the fourth line with the F clef, thus: — -6: " 8t2. |i^ ^•il: Each F, in whatever position, must be sharped, unless contradicted by ac- cidentals or a change of signature. The foregoing will be sufficient to indicate the manner in which all major modes and major scales are constructed, using each tone in turn, in our tone- system as the Tonic to such a mode or scale. The upper figures in the follow- ing table show the successive order of the Tonics, and at the same time the niuuber of sharps or flats which the mode upon that Tonic contains. The figures underneath indicate the successive order of the sharps and double- sharps, flats and double-flats. (8). t, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0, 1, fb!?, ebb, gbl?, jclbb, abb, ebb, bbb, | fb, cb, gb, db, ab, eb, bb 1 F, C, G, etc., 9, 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, (8). D, A, E, B, I fj, 4 g|, dj, aj, e| bj, | fx, ex, gx, dx, ax, ex, bx, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, etc. The tone C (0) is the Tonic of the normal mode which contains no flats or sharps, therefore F will be Tonic No. 1 in the modes with flats, and according to that figure, that mode contains one flat. Just so Bb is Tonic Xo. 2, and that mode contains two flats, and so on. In the same manner G is Tonic Xo. 1 in the modes with sharps, and that mode contains one sharp. D is Tonic Xo. 2, and its mode contains two sharps, &c. It will be observed that the mode of Fb major contains eight flats, and the mode of G]^, eight sharps, whereas we have but seven tones in a mode. In the mode of F {^) major there is one flat (Bb). Xow, if we apply a flat to each of the seven tones of that mode, the tone B will be doubly flatted ; i. e.., it will have two flats, which, together with one flat upon each of the six tones remaining, makes a total of eight. The key of G major has one sharp (F|*). If we apply a sharp to each oi the tones of that mode, the tone F becomes twice sharped, making a total of eight sharps in the mode of Gi major. Modes with more than seven or eight flats or sharps only present useless dif- ficulties, for in the present use of the Even 'J''emperament, a mode with eight sharps, for instance, may be expressed nwre simply with the use of four flats, or a mode of eight flats by the use of four sharps; further, it is not customary to MAX UAL OF MUSICAl. TIIEORY. 43 put more than s^emn sliarps or flats in the signal are. It is only in tr;'.iisiciit rliaiiges in the mode that so many altered tones present themselves, and they are then indicated by means of accidentals. Here will follow a general view of the various signatures, and, as will he ob- served, the order of writing the members of each signature is according to the order in which they were generated. Table of signatukes and tonics in kajor modes. 83. i Key of C. J__ =tfi 1st A. J fatjI gtA Mfe E. | it|j|;p p^ * _i^_ CS. H t. Key of C. a F. -^- Bb. k= Et,. Sei Gb. -^2Z5_L Cb. The figures indicating the time, should be placed immediately after ij^e sig- nature, for ex.: — 85. ~4r- UHAPTER YI. NORMAL MINOR MODE. NORMAL MINOR SCALE. As in the major mode, the Tonic, Sub-dominant, and Dominant-triads are of the first consideration. The character of the major is bright and aspiring; that of the minor is its antithesis, dark and dejected. Everything in the minor is the opposite of the major, therefore the Tonic-triad will be a minor triad. We find such an one upon A, as follows: — a, C, e. 44 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. The Sub-domiuaut and Dominant of A are D and E; thus, we have as fun daraentals: — Sub-dam. Tonic. Dom. d a e. Conti-ary to the major mode, minor triads must be formed upon these fun- damentals (see relationships of minor triads, page 39), thus: — Subdom.- triad. Tonic-triad. Dom. -triad. ^ F, ^a, C, e, G, b. These tones constitute the Normal Minor Mode, and,if arranged melodlcal ly, the result will be the Normal Minor Scale, thus: — 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 1, 8. ■Ascending: — A, V), C, Q, G, I, g, a. Descending.— A, g, f, £, d, C, b, a. 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1. Upon the two tones related in the third to the Tonic, viz: F and C, we find major triads, (see brackets L" I in the following scheme). d, F, a, C, e, G, b. ' These triads have each two tones common to the Tonic-triad, and thereby are closely allied to that accord. Upon two more distant tones, viz: B and G, we can also form triads, thus- d, F, a, C, e, G, b, d. The tones B, d, f, form a diminished, and G, b, d, a major triad, both of which are reltLtcd to the Tonic-triad only through the triads of the Sub-dorai- n;uit and Doitiinant. RESUME OF TRIADS IN THE NORMAL MINOR MODE. Three minor triads, respectiyely upon the Tonic, Sub-dominant, and Domi- nant. Three major triads: two upon those tones rela-ted in the third to the Tonic, and one on the 7th degree of the scale. One diminished triad, upon the second degree of the scale. In the major mode, the /S'uMominant-triad was made milder by depressing or flatting its third. Opposite to this, the Dominant-trvad in a minor mode, may be made bolder by elevating its third. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. ^5 . With this alteration, our scheme would present itself as follows: — ; The Tonic and Sub-dominant-triads remain minor accords, but the Dortv- tnan^triad is now major. The key can be equally well established with the proper use of these triads, or with those of the Normal Mode. Remabk. — No such alteration can be allowed in the third of the /Siift-dominant-triad in minor modes for the same reason that prohibits any alteration in the Dominant- triad of major modes, (see remark on that point, page 37). The Sub-dombiant-triad in a minor mode must always be minor. The alteration of the tone G to Gjlf, makes two additional triads possible, as per following scheme: — d, F, a, C, e, G% b, d. The tones C, e, G^, form an augmented triad on the third degree of the scale, and the tones G^, b, d, a diminished triad on the leading-tone (Gj|). SECOND FORM OF MINOR SCALE. Arranged alphabetically, commencing with the Tonic, the above schemee ^ill give us the second form of a minor scale, thus: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7*, 8. Ascending .— A, b, C, d, C, f, gjlf, A. Descending :—,A, gj^, f, e, d, C, b, A. 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1. THIRD FORM OF MINOR SCALE. Between P and G:||, the sixth and seventh degrees, there is an unpleasant interval, an augmented second, a progression decidedly unmelodic. To avoid this spring, the sixth degree may also be raised a small half-step producing thereby a melodic succession, as follows: — 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, T, 8. A, b, c, d, e, fj(, *g|, A. In this ascending scale the minor character is imparted by the third de- gree (c) which stands a minor third from the Tonic, thus in a measure coun- teracting the effect of the Y^,'^\i\.c\i, harmonically, cannot appear in the scale of A minor. The reason is this: the tone P is a component part of the 46 MANUAL OF MrSTCAL THE OB T. Sub-dominant-triad, which, in a minor mode, must always remain a minor triad. Tfie alteration to F:|f would create a major Sub-dominant-triad, hence, that tone cannot harmonically appear in the mode of A minor. The change, therefore, in order to improve the melodic character, can only be allowed where the harmonic element offers no objection. In the descending scale of the third form, the foreign character of the tone Fti to the scale of A minor, would be easily felt, as no tone precedes, tending to counteract that effect, as is the case in the ascending series. In order, therefore, to preserve the minor character of the descending scale, it is necessary to use the stem-tone ¥^, the third of the Sub-dominant-triad, and in order to avoid the spring from G^ to Ft}, the stem-tone Gt} is generally made use of. The third form in full will be as follows: — 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8. Ascending:- A, b, C, d, e, f^, g||, A. Descending:- A., gtf, ft}, 6, d, C, b, A. 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1. The first form of the minor scale is undoubtedly the most correct, but the last is generally considered most practical for both vocalists and instrumental- ists. The harmonic element however, influences the succession in such passages more than melodic considerations; hence, any one of the above forms are us- able, according to the demands of that element. The introduction of altered tones as upon the 6th or Tth degrees of the scale (see second and third forms) must of course be effected by means of accidentals. The signature, as we shall see in the following chapter, relates only to the Normal or first form. CHAPTER YII. GENERATION OF SIGNATURES IN MINOR MODES. We regard the mode of A minor as the Normal Minor Mode. According to its relationships all other minor modes are to be formed. MODE OF D MINOR. Taking for instance, as the Tonic, a next related tone to A, viz: D, our Tonic-triad will be — drTpa. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TnEOBY. 47 Minor triads upon the Sub-doraiuant and Dominant of D, viz: G and A, together with the Tonic-triad just given, constitute the mode of D minor, thus: — Sttb-dom.-triad. Tonic-triad. Dom.-triad. C BK T^fT^C C, ^e. Forming a minor triad upon G gives occasion for the use of a- flat (BI2), therefore the mode of D minor has one flat and its signature will be as fol- lows: — 86. I w =^ ^• ^ SCALE OF D MINOR. The above tones, arranged alphabetically, will furnish us the first form of the scale of D minor, thus: — 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8. Ascending:—^, 6, f, g, a, bjz, C, D. Descending:— Id, C, bb, a, g, f, 6, D. 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, 1. The second form of the scale, caused by the introduction of the major Dom- inant-triad (a, Cj|, e) into the mode, will be as follows: — 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, t, 8. Ascending :— Id , 6, f, g, a, blz, d^, D. X»esc, bt?, I _F, C, G, D, A, E, B, | _f ft eft gft 'dft aft eft The mode of A minor (0) is without flat or sharp, and is therefore the Normal Mode. The mode of D minor has one flat; that of G, two flats, &c. E minor has one sharp, B minor, two sharps, &c. E|f minor has eight sharps, the letter F being double-sharpeA, and D I? minor has eight flats, the letter B being double-Jiatted, (see comments on this subject, in major modes, page 42). MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 49 TABLE OF SIGXATUEES AXD TONICS IN MINOR MODES. SS.^' SO. PARALLEL MODES. These are such as have the same stem-tones and signatures; for ex.: the modes of C major and A minor; the modes of Elz major and C minor; Fj| major and D|| minor; Gb major and Eb minor, etc. EXERCISES. The following series of exercises has been proven in the author's teaching to be of decided practical value, as it not only furnishes a brief summary or re- view of the last few chapters, for the benefit of the pupil, but also enables the teacher to ascertain the pupils proficiency on the points referred to. The in- telligent teacher will of course present the questions in the manner and order which seems best adapted to each individual pupil. Name the order in which sharps succeed each other. Name the order in which flats succeed each other. Name all major modes containing sharps, in order of succession, and the let- ters sharped in each mode. Name all minor modes containing sharps, in order of succession, and the let- ters sharped. Name all major modes containing flats, in order of succession, and the let- ters flatted. Name all minor modes containing flats, in order of succession, and the letr ters flatted. Name all parallel modes containing sharps. Name all parallel modes containing flats. Name the parallel modes of any given signature, (for ex.: the parallel modes of " one sharp " are G major and E minor). Eemaek. — The last, deepest tone of a oompositiou generally shows whether a major or minor key is indicated by the signature. For the present, this is perhaps the best means of ascertaining this point. 50 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. * Name the tones of each major scale containing sharps, and order of succes- sion of the Tonics. Name the tones of each major scale containing flats, and order of succes- sion of tlie Tonics. Name the tones of each minor scale (3d form) containing sharps, and order of succession of the Tonics. Name the tones of each minor scale (3d form) containing flats, and order of succession of the Tonics. The following examples should be written in each different key with their appropriate signatures: — I SCALK OF MAJOE AND TRIAD OF C MAJOR WITH DOUBLINGS. A. oo fc= •i -0- v-*- f Scale of A minor (3d form) and triad of A jynNOR with doublings, j^ 91 .iE * • -:::5 I SCALE OF E|f MINOR. The third form of the minor scale ascending, written in the key of E^, Wis ten sharps, seven from the signature and three on account of accidental double- sharps. The descending scale has eight sharps. Ex: — 03. iSil^-^iS^l^ The above example gives occasion to notice the method of restoring a tone, which has been c^ou^^e-sharpcd, to its former position with one sl'iarp. In the above scale, the ascending series has a double-sharp upon the sixth and seventh degrees, (C x and D x) which, in descending, must be restored to the stem- tones (Dji and V^). The natund (tj) first cancels the double-sharp rn/iV, C, El?, g, B?, d. The Sub-dominant-triad of the similar-named minor mode has also one tone common to the Tonic of the major mode, (the tone C in the above scheme) . The minor Dominant-triad (g, Bl?, d), as previously remarked, cannot ap- pear as a related accord to the mode of C major, notwithstanding the fact of its having one tone common to the Tonic- triad of that mode. Its chai'acter is so foreign to the key of C major, that so soon as it appears the key is changed. The closest chord-relationships to the Tonic-triad of a major mode are therefore as follows: — The triads related in the third. The Sub-dominant and Dominant-triad. The triad upon the second degree of the scale. The Tonic and Sub-dominant triads of the similiar-named mode. Other chords more distantly related will be mentioned farther on. RELATED MODES The triads just mentioned, having been shown to be related, it now follows that the modes, whose Tonics are the fundamentals of these triads, are also related. The related modes of C major, therefore, are A and E minor; F and G major; C and F minor and the more distant mode of D minor. The following scheme exhibits the Tonics of the related modes to C major; the capitals indicate the major, and tlie small letters the minor Tonics, and the brackets etc., trace the relationship to C, whether direct or indirect: — ,•••.1 —II 1 5, I F, . a,— 0— e, G. I I f, c. RELATED TRIADS IN MINOR MODES. Having considered the relationships in major modes, we tnrn now to those in minor, and find upon those tones related in the third two major triads, each MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBY. gg having two tones common to the Tonic-triad, thus: — Further, the two minor triads upon the Sub-dominant and Dominant have each one tone common to the Tonic-triad. The triad G, b, D, has two tones (G and B) common to the Dominant-tri- ad, and thereby claims a secondary relationship with the Tonic-triad. As will be remarked, this triad is the exact opposite of the correspondingly related triad in the major mode. That in the major mode was a minor triad, related to the Tonic-triad through that of the AS'?^6-dominant. This one, in the minor mode, is a major triad related to the Tonic-triad through that of the Dom- inant. SIMILAR-NAMED MODE. The similar-named mode of A minor is A major. The Tonic-triads of these two modes have two tones common to each other. The Dominant-triad of the major mode (E, git, B), has also one tone common to the Tonic-triad of the minor mode (see scheme). d, F, a, C, e, G, b. D, fjj, A, 4_E^ gt,3 The major Sub-dominant-triad (D, f j|, A), however, occupies the same posi- tion towards the Tonic-triad of a minor mode that the minor Dominant-triad occupies towards that of a major mode. Its character is too foreign to enable it to be counted as a related accord. The closest chord-relationships in minor modes are therefore: — The Tonic-triad and those triads related in the third; The Tonic-triad and Sub-dominant and Dominant triads; The Tonic-triad and that triad upon the seventh degree of the scale; The Tonic-triad and tlie Tonic and DoD:iinant-triads of the similar-named mode. RELATED MODES. As in major, so in minor, the related modes are those whose tonics are the fundamentals of related accords. The related modes of A minor are there- fore F and C major, D and E minor, and the more distant modes of G, A and E major, (see following scheme). I II \.'". d. F— a— C, e, I G I I A, E. 54 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TUEORT. Other related accords and modes will be indicated in the proper place, tlie jjreseut purpose being fully served by the foregoing. CHAPTER IX. CONTINUATION OF THE CHAPTER ON METER AND RHYTHM. As remarked upon page 15, in order that a composition may be more easily comprehended, both by executant and auditor, it is divided into small sections of equal duration called Measures. These measures are sub-divided into two, three or more equal parts called Measural Divisions, and finally, accents are applied to certain regularly recurring parts according to the following princi- ple, viz: Of every two metrical members, the first is accented, and the sec- ond unaccented. TWO-PART METER. In the following examples, the meter is each time two-part, and, as this fur- nishes two metrical members, the first part will be accented and the second unaccented, according to the above principle. 03 _^ ^ 12 12 12 If, in two-part meter, the metrical divisions are half notes, as in the first of the above examples, the time can be indicated either by the figures (-^) or by the letter g with a perpendicular stroke through it, thus: ]^. The time is called in such cases Alia Breve, and the accent falls on only tlie first part. THREE PART METER. In measures of three parts there are two accents, one on the first antl Uje other on the second, e. g. 12 12 12 P V ' V ' V ' 12 12 12 An accent more or less forcible falls upon each alternate note or part. Alter a stroke comes the recoil; hence the origin of the foregoing [jrinciple, "Of ev^ry two metrical members, " etc. In three-part meter, the second part stands as a first metrical member to the tliird i)art, consequently, the second part, as well as the first, is accented (see example), but, as this second part nnist also stand as the recoil, so to sjM'alc, (if the first part, its accent cannot be so intense or forcible as that on the first part. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TUEOEY. g^ PRIMARY AND SECONDARY ACCENT. Here arises two degrees of accent, the strongest of which falls always upou the first part. This will be called the Primary accent, and the other the Sec- ondary accent. All other varieties of meter are compounds of the two above ineutioned. / A composition may begin upon an accented or unaccented part of the meas- /ure at pleasure. In case it begins with'a fractional part of a measure, an / equal length of time must be deducted from the last measure of the movement / or piece, so that the two fractional parts may together make onefull measure { (see following examples). feZTI V t V ' V ' V 1 A ' V ' W4-^- -r — * — F — -i 1 1 4—1— — F — ■- ~\ . \ L^_ '^ -* F F- -1 ^-4- ^-'--- Rests may take the place of notes, e. g. ««-p -f—f^^^—f- - f r r - ^ ^S Several or all of the parts of a measure may be contracted into one note equal to their united duration, e. g. ' 12 3 1 2 or. 'zr_ One, several, or all of the parts of a measure may be sub-divided into notes of shorter duration, e. g. 31 2 3 1231 2.3 12 OS. The regular succession of the equal divisions of time which compose the measures, as we have already stated, is called the JNIeter, and the diversified method of filling out the Meter, as suggested above, is termed the Rhythm. BI-MEASURAL RHYTHM. If two measures, rhythmically ordered, are succeeded by two others con- taining the same rhythm, the passage is said to be in hi-mea^^ural rlwjlhm. To preserve or to secure perfect symmetry, it is always necessary that a defi- nite rhythm be repeated. Ex. : — 90 A coesura or rhythmical punctuation point occurs at the end of each section. In writing, this may be indicated by a point ( ' ), and in performance by an instant's silence between the sections, the time of which is to be taken 66 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. from the final note of each section. Written with strict regard to punctuation, the above example, in Allegro tempo, would be correctly expressed as follows, I. e., with an eighth-rest at the close of each section: — lOO i EE -#— #-—#-^=s JJ_^..^_#_ i^ Few writers, however, are so scrupulous in this respect, presuming that the executant's culture in the art of phrasing is such as not to require punctuation points. TRI-MEASURAL RHYTHM. A passage, in which three measures, rhythmically ordered, are succeeded by three others of like rhythm, is said to be in tri-measural rhythm, for ex.: — lOl. U o 1 #^ ^ ^^ ^ f • ^ 1* » m >» ^ (" 1* • ]• * 1* * r ; r \ V jy ■* 1 1 -i b^— ^ — — 1 j A U-^— -1 — ; J The varieties of rhythm most easily comprehended and retained are those whose sections contain two, three, four or eight measures. More than eight is difficult for the auditor to keep in mind. Rhythm is one of the most varied and efifective agents which the composer can call to his aid. To illustrate this, we give below a few examples of the possi- ble varieties of rhythm in two-part meter. The lower notes indicate the met- ric succession and accents, and the upper notes the rhythmic. 103 h M n i*^ n n •ixicraiizcc^rrTgizrexr^^gzisazro:*:*:! -# — 1# — #-Ltf— iT^L^ — fi — L* — *-S-# — # — L, — — I i ^ ^ -# ^0 0- z=r-l I I' r ■^-JT-a-^ ^ .*^N. B.^ ^ h • — 0- SYNCOPE. At N.B. of the above example, a rhythm arises which is called Syncopa- tion. A Syncope is a note whose entrance takes place unaccented, and whose duration continues past the next recurring accent. In the example here, viz: N.B. 103. if V— m the tied note at N.B. enters unaccented, and the next accent fixlls wliile tliis note is being sustained. There are really four metrical members iu each of MANUAL OF MVSICAL. THEOEY. 57 the above measures, instead of two, as will be seen if the notes are reduced to the same kind throughout, thus: — 104.. There being four metrical members, it yields two accents in each measure, a primary and secondary upon the first and third parts respectively. In the original example, the second and third parts were expressed by quarter-notes in each measure, and, according to the last method of writing, those quarter- notes enter unaccented but are held past the next recurring accent (see Ex. 104). They are therefore syncopes, as well as the tied note. The following are a few examples of the varieties of rhythm in three-part meter, the lower notes, as before, showing the metric succession and accents, and the upper the rhythmic. 105 I I ^ M I J I r^ r; r r; 106 m I ! . I I ^Hl^ J- ^^^m, :^z=st ^^1^^ 0-'-0 0-'-0 #— *-# "' ^ f ^ VARIETIES OF MEASURE. There are two kinds of simple measure, one with two parts (Even Measure), and the other with three (Uneven Measure). The duration of each part, whether half-note, or quarter-note etc., makes no difference whatever with the kind of measure; that is determined simply by the number of purts. The varieties of simple measure are as follows: — Even.— _^ ^ ^ Uneven: — ± ± ± -2- 4- -8- 58 MAXUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. COMPOUND MEASURES. All other kinds of measure are compounds of the two above given. For ex : A, or " common time," as it is frequently called, is a compound of -2 , thus: — ( Compound:-^ l' J i' J lor. 3 I t I ( Simple.- I" f * I r I* The diflPerence between simple and compound measures lies in the intensity of the accents; thus, in the above example, the common or A. time has a secondary accent on its third part, whereas the 2., from which the A is com- pounded, has a pnmary accent upon this point, it being n first part in the simple measure. In like manner, A. time is the compound of 3_, e. g. Compound:-^ vl j J J j J V ' V » In A time the accents are primary and secondary, respectively upon the first and second parts, while in 6 time, the secondary accent falls upon the fourth part, and still lighter or tertiary accents on the second and -fifth parts (indica- ted by dots), these latter corresponding to the places of the secondary accents in 2l time. 4 Measures in 9. time are compounded from A, e. g. 8 8 109 , ^'"^"""'^•-t iT; fn 'JTj 108 simpu:- I rrj Ym YJJ The accents in ^ time are primary, secondary and tertiary, falling respec- tively upon the first, fourth and seventh parts, while, in the simple measures {3l^ compounding the -|. time, each of those accents were primary. Meas- . s . " 9 2 ores m -^ tune are compounded from ^ and"o- thus: — /5, vj • I i 'l J ^ vl"^ 'i •! J «. V I • or "^ f V ' 3 0\2^ 2 #«|3## 8 '—J 18 In -^ time, we have given two modes of accent, either of which is correct, the secondary falling on the third, or fourth part at will. This,of course, con- trols the fall of the tertiary accent, causing it to occur upon the fifth or sec- ond part, according as the secondary falls on the third or fourth parts. Similar to the last example, 7 time is a compound of A and 3:, (See second line in o 8 ■&" MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY 59 ,,- i Pl'X » O t Ex. Ill) and, as A is a compouncT of 2. (see third line in Example 11 l),it fol- lows that 7 is partly a doable-compound. Its necondary and tertiary accents vary, there being two modes of grouping, on account of the uneven number of parts, the same as in i»- time, e. g. ■ * XT 7 8 4 2 ^ 8 ' — I 1^— J I 8 : — ■ — ! 8 'L— ' — I I 8 On account of the irregular fall of the accent, measTrt'f^s containing five or seven parts are seldom used : their performance requires at least both the primary and secondary accent if intelligibility is to be ensured. There is also a very slight accent on the third or sixth part, according to the place of the secondary. An en'or is fallen into occasionally in regard to the placing of the accents in &- time and -3. time, when the rhythm of each moves in eicrhth- 8 4- * notes. Ex. 112 presents the correct accentuation in both cases. ILj'ltLl. A Llj'I-^ 113. I- m V ' ^ o 4 '^ L. Table of Accents or all Even, Uneven, Sijiple and CoivrpouND Measures. Simple. 118. Uneven : ir h : |3 ^ i If I I n-l ■-'\ V f 1 CoiMPODND. Even ;— -p- ■Uneven :-^rjJfJc 1^000 I -^^ 00000 00\ 8 00000 000 000% ^000001'y »0»9 000C,y 000 0000 t 9 000000000 I U ^-J I 8 ^ ^ lU '^ I 8 --J --J --i I ARTIFICIAL ACCENTS. These are such as are temporarily applied in order to express any certain desired eflect which would not be secured by the ordinary accents, for ex.: — 115. i pi %-- 3: t :t • At a, PJx. 115, an artificial accent is applied on an unaccented part of the measure, more intense than the primary; at 6, the accents are replaced by Budden ci-e.-itendos; at c, a passage in -^ time is made to produce the effect of ~ p 4 &c. 60 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEORT. CHAPTER X. FORMATION OF MELODIES, jyiELODIC PASSAGES AND CLOSES, OR FINAL CADENCES. The first efforts should be simple and entirely singable; therefore, such in- tervals should be chosen as are naturally melodic, and the unmelodic avoided. Among all the intervals that it is possible to form xtodh tine stem-tones of a major mode, only three are unmelodic; one, a; major fourth, the other two, ma- jor sevenths. We present below, a table of all the intervals in C major, start- ing from' each tone in the mode. 11,111, 4, V, TI, Tlf, yjlljll, 3, 4, 7. VI, 7, Vfn.|2, 3, 4, V, 6, 7, M.lll, HI, if, 7, 71, VH. YIII. 116. a. -•-/« 0-^- #-#■ • #- -•-# »-^ :3: -f II, III, 4, V, VI, 7, ttll, 1 ^ , 0—P-, n, 3, 4, V, 6, 7, VIII, r 5---—'-^ 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7. Vm. b.^ ry-^* " I ^ ~» ^ ' ^J — -f ' ■ ^ J ■ <^-- 1 IIG. The asterisks (x) note the unmelodic intervals ; all the rest are melodic. We find, then, by way of recapitulation, that the most melodic, most singable intervals are — Ilajor and minor seconds ; Major and minor thirds ; minor fourths ; Major and minor ffths ; Major and minor sixths ; minor sevenths ; Major octaves. The unmelodic intervals are — Major fourths ; Major sevenths. THE TRI-TONE. The major fourth is called a Tri-tone, on account of its compass being three whole steps. In the mode of C major, it occurs between F and B, and the major sevenths between^ and B, and F and E, thus: — Tritone. ^^ iir. IV, ^37.- -J2r- IV below. '*' Vn, VII below. vn, VII below. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TUEORT. 61 Further, all diminished and augmented intervals, in addition to the major fourth and major seventh, are unmelodic,though, in modern compositions, they often appear, and, by artistic mauigulation, are made singable. For tlie present, it will be better to avoid their use. MELODIC CLOSE. The close or final note of a melody must begin and end upon an accented part of the measure, and, further, upon one of the tones of the Tonic-triad, The Tonic, itself, furnishes the firmest, most satisfactory close; the third is less complete, and the fifth is the weakest of the three. The Tonic, therefore,, will best answer our present purpose, and it is to be remarked that the tones best adapted to precede the Tonic in a melodic close, are the leading-tone (a half-step l>elow) ; the major second (a whole-step above), and the Dominant, used above or below (not the ^Si^ft-domiuaut), e. g. , Vaeteties of close upon the Tonic th Major Modes. &• ^ c. ^ , d. fe lis. W -i2 — -_ cp ffi -6^ is: P £ It is stated above that the final note of a melody must begin and end upon an accented part of the measure. At a, Ex. 118, the time being alia breve, the accent falls only on the first part of the measure, therefore the final-note must begin ^ith that part. The following closes according to this, would be incorrect, inasmuch as the final note enters or is begun in both cases unaccented, e. g. no. m ¥ ZSL. Again, as the time is alia breve, the metrical divisions are half-notes, there- fore the final note, in order to end on an accented part of the same measure, must not be longer than a half-note ; any note shorter than that is quite cor- rect (See Ex's, below), or in case of a tied note prolonging the close into a succeeding measure, as at/ in Ex. 120, the final, or last note of the tie must not exceed a half-note. L20.^^ Incorrect Incorrect. Correct. w S^^SZ^. ^ The final note in Ex's. d. and e, being longer than a half-note, their close would take place unaccented; they are therefore incorpect. At b, of Ex. 118, the time is, as before, alia breve; the final note is a whole-note, which of itself would end unaccented, but a pause (/tn) is placed over it, and the performer is left to sustain it indefinitely, always remembering, however, to suspend the tone upon the accent. 62 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. This is an invariable rule with regard to the observance of the pause, a rule which, through carelessness or ignorance, is often disregarded. At c and d, Ex. 118, the time being A or common-time, there are accents upon the first 4 -and third parts of the measure ; hence, the final note may enter and close upon either of those parts. Varieties of Close upon the Tonic in JIinor Modes. b- . ^ c. K d. A i. ± 131. 3 :#=^: In 3. time, it will be remembered that there are two accents, a primary 4 and secondary, upon the first and second parts of the measure. The^nal note may begin and end on either of these parts, or it may begin on the first and end on the secohd,as at s of Ex. 121. At b, of the same example, the final note ■fills the measure and would end, were it not for the pause, upon an unaccented part; the pause, however, prolongs it at will, but must finally cease on an ac- cent; for ex., supposing, instead of the pause, the prolongation were written out, it would necessarily be expressed similar to the following examples: — 133 etc. The foregoing are the firmest melodic closes; others will follow in their prop- er olaces FORMATION OF MELODIES. The first note of a melody (in the primary efforts at least) should be one of the tones of the Tonic-triad, as this is most natural and most singable. The simplest form of a melody is that in bi-raeasural rhythm. The first thing to be done is the" formation of two measures, in any rhythm which the fancy of the composer may dictate, for ex.: — 133 SECTION. The two measures thus rhythmically ordered, i. e., possessing well-defined motion and ending with a certain degree of repose, constitute a Section, and, in order to fulfill all the conditions of bi-measural rhythm, there must be two additional measures containing the same rhythm, for ex.: — ' -^1 — -I 134. -~^- £ s=^ :^ ±jtt -I-— - — » *-i A different effect is g-ained by changing the fall of the accent, e. g. 136.feE I 0-^ -S>-r^ E il #-# tr: The tones of the original motive occupied contiguous staff-degrees. Passa- ges formed in the same manner are said to be in strict style. The introduc- tion of different intervals from those in the motive, is termed /?re style, e. g. ^^ -"irV -^-0- . --«-. „*„ ^^ ^ -"^ I .■■**«. isr.^ e^^ '-^ fZ-f. E^li tm^r^rqne #-s^ The strict and free style may be united, e. g. 138. -*-• j — \-^iG>~ ^» Chromatic tones may be employed, e. g. etc. 130. Ca=t=t i 2rt22*- %i? "^^ *^' g^^ The direction of a part of the motive may be altered, e. g. 140. ^^-^Tfi?-* * feifjfz ■1 — d-*- - I — #^ etc. 141 Augmentation, e. g. 1^ -^ -a.-^: ^^v'^r^G-s ^il=ii^^^ :s?ir 143 Diminution, e. g. -P-T J iij*:notc. It should be remarked that an efficient way of constructing passages from Bhort motives, is to repeat the motive in such a way as to increase its compass, as seen in the first half of the last example. Sequences or rejiotitions of Ihi.s longer motive may then follow, thus adding greatly to the numl)er and variety of the passages possible to form. The above are a few, only, of the multitude MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 67 of var'uuions possible to this single group of three notes. Thorough practice with various motives is earnestly recommended, since by means of this, more than auythiiig else, skill in the invention and development of themes is ac- quired. Readiness in this art is, to the composer, what a fine technique is to the pianist, — a means to an end. CHAPTER XI. THE CONSONANT TRIAD. VARIOUS POSITIONS OF TRIADS. Whether major or minor, this triad contains only consonant intervals, and the duplication or doubling of any or all of its tones effects no alteration; on the contrary, if each tone is once doubled, above and below, we shall find that the chord contains all the consonances which exist in the sphere of music. Ex. 143 presents the consonant major triad with duplications above and be- low: — 143 .sgJij; The intervals indicated by the curved lines are as follows: — A major prime (C and C). A major third (C and E). A major fifth (C and G). A major sixth (G and E). A major octave (C and C, E and E, G and G). A minor third (E and G). A minor fourth (G and C). A minor sixth (E and C). These constitute the consonant intervals ; all others whatsoever are dissonant, and the introduction of any other interval into the above triad (Ex. 143) would cause the whole chord to become dissonant. All these consonances are present in the minor triad; that accord is therefore consonant, e. g. 14=-* DIFFERENT VOICES. In the following studies, we shall have to deal in general with harmonies containing four parts, which will be termed Voices. They will be further des- ignated after the principal divisions of the human voice; thus, the highest part 68 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TREORY. Avill be called the Soprano; the next to the highest, Alto; the next to the low- est, Tenor; and the lowest of all, Bass. We shall refer to the Soprano as the upper voice; to the Bass as lower voice, and to the Alto and Tenor as 7niC?cZ^e voices; collectively, the Soprano and Bass will be spoken of as outer voices. The compass of the respective voices in ordinary cases is as follows: — a. b. ... c. _ d. Soprano. .^^ 14.5 When using the Gr clef, the Tenor is sung an octave lower, in the compass indicated by the Bass or F clef at d. • THE BASS. The Bass of an accord is always the lowest tone, it matters not how high or how low the accord may be situated, e, g. a. ,._ - I4:6.2z=s: ^n ie»- At a, of the above ex. the Bass of the accord is C, its lowest tone; at h, the Bass is E ; and at c, it is G. THE FUNDAMENTAL. The Fundamental Bass, or simply fundamental, differs from the ordinary Bass, in being that tone over which all the other tones of the accwd stand third-wise; i. e., in thirds, one above the other, or over which those tones can be so arranged. To discover the fundamental, all the tones must be brought into the third-wise position, if not already so, and then the fundamental will be the lowest tone. In the examples immediately following, the fundamental in each accord is indicated by a whole note. 14=7 . ^■■^^^ The a1)0ve triad already presents the third-wise position; therefore, C is the fundamental. It is also the Bass, since it is the lowest tone, a. b. 7=\' »^T— » -1 The accord at a, Ex. 148, is not already in the third-wise position, its compo- nent intervals being a third (E — G) and a fourth (G — C). The Bass is E, but the fundamental is only to be learned by arranging the triad in the third-wise position, which is accomplished by transposing the C an octave lower, as at b, MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 69 (same ex); C, then, is theyioitflamfijito/, whether the chord stand as at a or as at6> while the Bass in one case is E, and in the other, C. In the following ex. at a, we find a fifth (C — G) and a sixth (G — E), but,by placing the E an octave lower, as at 6, tlie third-wise position is gained, show- ing C, as before, to be the fundamental: — a. ±' b. 140 .P^=i In Ex. 150 at a, we have two sixths (G — E and E — C). In order to dis- cover the fundamental, it will be necessary to transpose the G an octave high- er, and the G an octave lower, as at b. As he^ovQ, the fundamental is C, e. g. a. b. 150 m -0'- Duplicate tones, as in Ex. 151, a, b, are to be disregarded in the en- deavor to discover the fundamental; first, cancel such tones, and then, if ne- cessary, arrange the remainder in the thbd-wise position and the fundamental •will appear, e. g. a.W b.-ih ISl .1^ CLOSE POSITION. The Close Position of an accord is that in which the staff-degrees corres- ponding to the letters of that accord are contiguously occupied, e. g. 15 3 -21^3 In the last three examples, at &, only the upper three voices are in close po- sition, since, between the Bass and Tenor,there are several chord-degrees unoc- cupied (indicated by the cipher, 0). OPEN OR DISPERSED POSITION. This is naturally the opposite of the close position; it is that position of an accord, the voices of which do not occupy each contiguous chord-degree, e. g. a.ti b. ^ c. J d. J. 153 m IZISI At a, Ex. 153, there are two chord-degrees unoccupied, an E and C; the accord is therefore said to be in open position. The same is to be said of the chords at b, o and d. 70 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. Fundamental POSITION OF A Triad. (Major, Minor, Diminished or A ii This oral exercise should then follow: — 1. Let the teacher give any letter as fundamental and require the pupil to name the letters forming the Fundamental position (close) of a major, minor, diminished or augmented triad upon that fundamental. Then, give the ar- rangement of the letters necessary to form the Third-Sixth and Fourth-Sixth positions of the various kinds of triad. 2. Let the teacher name the letters forming a triad and require the pupil to give the fundamental thereof, and also the position in which the letters stand, for ex.: — Teacher: "Name the fundamental and position of the triad E, G, C." Pupil: "It is the triad of C major and its Third-Sixth position." After consid- erable familiarity with the close positions has been attained, exercises should follow upon triads in open position. In these, the difficulty to the pupil will be lessened if he instantly arranges the tones in his mind in close position, as they are given out by the teacher, building up the chord upon the first given letter as the Bass. CHAPTER XIL Figured Bass, (Thorough Bass, General Bass, etc). Duplication, Omission, Voice Motion. The remaining tones of an accord above the Bass can be indicated by means of figures, e. g. 5 3 5 3 3 5 C\' a )• ».^ rj /^ /S i>r3 -<5 Each of the above methods are employed to indicate to the performer that the remaining tones of the triad in its Fundamental position are to be added 72 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. to the Bass, C, viz; the third (E), fifth (G) and usually the octave (C). The absence of the figure in the last of the above examples is to be coustrued as indicating the same thing as the figures in those preceding. The exact arrangement of the abbreviated voices, one above the other, must be left entirely to the performer's good judgment, as the figures do not pretend in the least to indicate any one of the multiform arrangements of the tones possible to even one position. The connection of the harmonies, one after the other,is, however, a matter which the thorough study of Harmouy will make clear. ACCIDENTALS. A single accidental, in place of a figure, always refers to the third of the note over or under which it is placed, e. g. 121 The third of C, viz: E, is hereby flatted, made natural or sharped accord ing to sign applied. It is usual to indicate the sharping of any other inter- val than the third by means of a stroke through the figure, thus: — $, ^, $, $, /}, instead of a s/ia?7:) placed before the figure, thus: — j^2. If a fiat or natu- ral occurs they are placed as in the following ex.: — « # 160 .9- ZSE. :zr- --^--~ If Ex. 160 were written out, instead of being abbreviated, it would appear, according to one of the many ways of placing the tones, as follows: — 161, gEgjE^jE^gl ^lfP The mode of figuring or abbreviating the Third-sixth position, or Third-sixth accord, is as follows, (Ex. 162), the last occurring perhaps theoftenest. The figure 6 is always necessary in abbreviating this position, but should either of the other intervals be altered by accidentals, their representative figures and accidental signs must also be added. 103. m The Fourth-sixth position, or Fourth-sixth accord is alwaya abbreviated b/ one of the two'methods indicated in the following ex.: — 1G3 .9- = MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 73 Care must be taken to indicate the fijjured members of the liarmony cor- rectly: for instance, if it were desired to abbreviate the accord G^, C^, Ejji, it would not be sufficient to place the simple figures 4 and 6 over the Bass ((ifi), as at a in the following Ex., (164) as that would imply the addition of the tones Ct[ and Ejij. Since C and E are to be sharped, this must be indicated by the figures, as at h in the same ex.: — 6 ^ a. I b. 4 164 m -^- -P- For the purpose of familiarizing the eye with the various positions of the triad, an exercise similar to the following is recommended. Let the pupil name the fundamental, mode and position of each accord in the following ex- amples : a. ^ b. ^ 16? For the sake of encouraging a clear and systematic manner of describing a chord, we give a model, below: — The first accord, at a, is the triad of A minor in its Fundamental position. The second accord, at a, is the triad of A minor in its Third-sixth position. The third accord, at a, is the triad of A minor in its Fourth-sixth position. The first accord, at 6, is the triad of A minor in its Fundamental position. The second accord, at b, is the triad of A minor in its Fundamental position. The third accord, at b, is the triad of A minor in its Fundamental position. The chord is reckoned from the Bass upward; at a, the Bass of the three triads is A, C and E respectively, while at b, the Bass is each time A. DUPLICATION OR DOUBLING AND OMISSION OF ACCORD TONES. As already remarked, any or all of the members of an accord may be doubled above or below, e. g. 166 3i^ So long as the position remains the same, the. identity of the accord is not altered by this duplication of its tones. In writing for four voices, it is most 74 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. usual to double the fundamental, but, wherever it seems more expedient, the third or Jiflh may be doubled instead, e. g. ler. OMISSION OF ACCORD TONES. If it is desirable or necessary to omit any member of a triad, the Jifth will be least missed. This is frequently done even in orchestral compositions where 60 many instruments are at command; sometimes in the final accord. In the compositions of former times, the third was often omitted; very nearly always in the final accord, on account of a rule which then prevailed, viz: "the close must be perfect; the octave and ffth are perfect, the third is not," e. g. 16 S m 'jszn. We are not satisfied with this form of the triad, at the present day, espec- ially as a close, as the third is regarded fuller. The omission of the third, therefore, occurs very seldom. VARIETIES OF VOICE MOTION, 1. Plane Motion is that in which one or more voices remain stationary while one or more voices move only rhythmically, i. e., repetition on the same pitch, e. g. 16© 2. Oblique Motion is that when one or more voices remain stationary and one other voice mpves toward or away from them, spring or degree-wise (see Ex. 170). Kemaek. — By d^ree-voise is to be understood from one staff-degree to the nest, and by spring-wise, from one staff-degree to any other excepting the next N.B. lyo I P^ -j^ is: :i=i=h=i=^ fTi^"^- jr—^ The upper voice at N. B. can be regarded as stationary, in the sense that it does not move from its degree. 8. Contrary Motion is that in which two voices move simultaneously toward ,or away from each other, spring or degree-wise, e. g. 171 m nzz -X Ij^fr MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 75 4. Similar Motion is that in which the voices move in the same dii'ectiou fiiniultaneonsl}', spring or degree-wise, e. g. -J- • m ■ "s^ ^ m t-f i^ ^ 1 r^ i= ^ 1— a*-! ■ i^n ^^ 1 **^ 173.1 ^^^^m 5. Parallel Motion arises when each of the voices move the same number of staff-degrees in the same direction simultaneously, spring or degree-wise, e. g. 173.| ¥ 3rr , , T^— |— 1 p— vm VIII V V Parallel Motion is always similar, but the reverse is not always true. CONSECUTIVE OCTAVES AND FIFTHS. The last two examples in Parallel Motion are what is termed Consecutivo or Open, or Parallel Octaves and Fifths. Such progressions in harmonic combinations are always to he avoided as false leading of the voices. Par- allel fifths, in which the first is*a major and the second a minor fifth, are fre- quently found in standard compositions, as at a in the following example, but the reverse, as at b, a minor and then a major fifth, is not to be allowed. a. b. 174. ^ II I I V 5 5 V COVERED OCTAVES. When two voices move into an octave in similar motion, either open or covered octaves result. An example of open octaves is given at a in the fol- lowins", and one of covered octaves at b: — i=ia -w-l 175 s By filling out the space degree-wise between G and C of Ex. 175, b, the oc- tave succession will clearly appear; hence the expression covered octave, e. g. jS^.- 176. -S- 1 COVERED FIFTHS. When two voices move into a fifth in similar motion, the result is either open, as at a, or covered ffths, as at b, in the following example: — 177 i ^^ ' 76 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. If the space between C and A, at h, of the foregoing example, be degree- wise filled out, the succession of fifths will be at once apparent, thus: — 178. 2^: 'S=z^ ^ r m Covered octaves and fifths are allowable except in certain cases, an explana- tion of which will appear later. The following chord-connection contains both covered octaves and fifths cor- rectly used; it is left to the student to discover them. lyo. :sc =^=t=i 12: glEE :^ It is suggested that the teacher make use of this and other examples to as- certain if the varieties of voice motion are fully understood by the pupil. CHAPTER XIII. BROKEN CHORDS. AUXILIARY TONES. APPOGGIATURA. PASSING-NOTES. BROKEN CHORDS. (ARPEGGIOS). A chord, as at a, Ex. 180, may be represented by one voice, to which the tones of that chord are given successively, as at b, or c. A chord performed in this manner is said to be broken, or in arpeggio form. a. .^ h. ^ c. ^^-— ♦■ 3^^ ISO. r aieEi^Ee^^^te^s^^ An accord may also l)e represented by two or more voices in arpeggio, either in contrary or similar motion, e. g. 181. fe^^ii^ etc. is^^ga MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 77 AUXILIARY TONES. Every tone of an accord \\i\i two auxiliary tonc^, viz: its wroy/rZ above and below. We give at a, Ex. 182, the chord only, and at 6, c, d and e, the vari- ous methods in which the auxiliary tones of a single member of the chord may be used. Notice at d and e that the auxiliaries follow each other (see aster- isks x). 18i2. a. n Nil C. , * 1 '■ \ 'r^ ' e. ^ * y ^ ' \ m ^1 1 /L.i^ ^ * * (C' * * '5' • J • « ' 1 C/ \ fm* ■- 1 "V n _^f^ ^^ 1 •J ^ C\' '^ -'.- L -I The C,in the Tenor, connects the two harmonies, while the Soprano and Alto progress, in contrary motion to the Bass, to the nearest tones necessary to complete tlie F major triad. The second fall of the fundamental a fifth would be from F to B, thus: — aie §i^ The first attempt to sing the above Bass would show it to be not melodical, jwing to the relation between C and B, a minor ninth. The progression of the Bass in this variety of triad-succession will be much improved if each alternate fundamental rise a fourth, the inversion of a fifth. We now present a completed example, and, as will be noticed, the chords are connected by a single tone. 17. N.B. The Bass will now be found singable notwithstanding the Iri-tone between F ii,\\(\ li (N. ^^.), but the reversion of its direction, rising instead of falling, yields gimilar motion with the other voices, which, iu polyphonic harmonies, very often produces open or covered fifths or octaves. In this case, at N. B., the Basgi and Soprano exliibit a covered octave, but, as the chords are connected by one tone (F),th(' succession is admissible. The worst feature of the example at N. B., is the progres.siou from the F major triad directly into the diminish'.'ii MANUAL OV MUSICAL TITEOliY. 89 triad upon the leading-tone (B). It sounds very crude in this position, and is to be tolerated only in behalf of the present object, viz: pi^actice in chord- connection. The Bass proceeds in regular sequence, and of course the leading- tone occurs in its turn as fundamental. While the covered octave at N. B. is pern)itted even in the outer voices, as it occurs here, it would not be allow- able to fill out the space between F and' B, as in the following example, for then, ojjen octaves would result. 31S. It will be seen that covered octaves result in Ex. 211 at each rise of the fundamental, between the Bass and one of the inner voices, but they are less noticeable than the one pointed out between the outer voices, therefore less ob- jectionable, if any discrimination were to be made. The covered octaves, how- ever, in this example may be wholly avoided, if desired, by means of a some- what freer leading of the voices, viz: by the use of sequences applied to all tlie voices. SEQUENCE. A sequence is the similar repetition of a melodic or harmonic figure. For example, if we take the following harmonic figure, in which i\ie fundamental falls a fifth:— 210. 1 1 y I cf 1 JL.iV ^^ ^ ^^ ^ ^ 1 •^ -«- 1 f^* L ' 1^ 1 i'/r • "^ ^ tp 1 1 1 and form similar repetitions, using the same Bass as in Ex. 217, the result will be a sequence, and the covered octaves will disappear, e. g. S30. In our model, Ex. 219, the Soprano of the first accord has the thi7'd of the fundamental, the Alto the octave, and the Tenor the fifth. The first accord of each repetition in the alcove sequence is arranged in tlie same manner. The second accord in the fiffure is connected to the first in the 90 MAJ^UAL OF MUSICAL THEORY . usual mauner. Tlie result of this freer leading of the voices is that contrary inotioa is secured, thereby rendering the occurrence of covered or open octaves an impossibility. DEPRESSION TO RELATIVE DEGREES BY MEANS OF MAJOR TRIADS. If we cause the fundamental of a major triad to foil a major fifth, or rise a minor fourth at each progression, and a major triad be formed upon that new fundamental, we come each time upon the Tonic-triad of a new key, which we will call, for want of a better term, one relative degree lower. RELATIVE DEGREE. By this term we mean to express that key which has one more flat or sharp, or one less flat or sharp in its signature than the key to Avhich we regard it ag related. Two relative degrees lower would imply that the related key had two aduitioiial flats, or two sharps less in its signature; two relative degrees higher would imply the reverse, viz: two flats less or two additional sharps, etc. Thus, we call the key of F major one relative degree below the key of C major, and the key of Bj? major, two relative degrees below the key. of C ma- jor. Just so, the key of G major is one relative degree above C major, and D major two relative degrees above C major, etc. By means of this depres- sion, and further on, by elevation, to relative degrees we are enabled to form cliord-successions which shall touch all the different keys, au achievement of decided value to the practical harmonist. The first depression of the fundamental of the Tonic-triad of C major, a major fifth, brings us to the key of F major; the second depression of a ma- jor fifth gains the key of Bj? major; the third, El? major, and so on, each suc- cession being connected, as before, by one tone, e. g. 331. <: i^^^^ ^S^EE '-% ±3?: Effi E.x. 222 presents the mode of depression to relative degrees with the use of sharps, the removal of each sharp eflecting a depression of one degree. The pupil is to fill out the upper voices according to the figuring, remembering that the first accord may be placed with the octave, third or fifth of the fundamental as Soprano, according to option. This remark applies to all the exercises in chord-succession which the pupil may practice. $ Si 323. ^:{* rJ:EEE»g ^ ! "T rgr it g? MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOEY. 91 DEPRESSION TO RELATIVE DEGREES BY MEANS OF MINOR TRIADS. If the fundamental of a iniiu)r triiid is (lei)re.sse(l a major (iftli, and anoth- er uiinor triad is formed upon that new fundamental ,\i will be the Tonic-triad of a minor key, cue relative degree lower, e. g. etc. 333. Ex. 224 with sharps, and, as before, only minor triads are to appear. I etc. 334.. feii ti^E^EEi^Ei^ TRIAD-SUCCESSION IN WHICH THE FUNDAMENTAL RISES A FIFTH. The very same rules and suggestions apply here as were given in the exer- cises where the /wnrfame?jtaZ /a/As a fifth. The first consideration is always connection of the harmonies. After the Bass of the exercise and the first accord have been written, seek out and write down the tone which is to con- -nect the next harmony. The progression of the remaining voices is then sira. ply to the nearest places in the new accord which are left unoccupied. Where the fundamental rises a fifth, as here, one tone, only, connects the triads, while two progress to their places in contrary motion to the Bass. If the direction of the Bass is reversed, falling a fourth, covered fifths arise, which are allow, able so long as the chords are connected by even one tone. Care must be ta- ken, however, with the introduction of passing-notes, where the Bass falls, lest the covered fifths become open fifths. If the fundamental were to actually rise a fifth, twice in succession, thus: — 33.5. 9*- the same unraelodic Bass would result, as referred to in Ex. 216. This can be avoided by alternately causing the Bass to fall a fourth, the inversion of the fifth. Ex. 226 presents a triad-succession according to the above suggestions. 92 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 336. 1^ _(2-. _j: iifESE; -is- N.B. At N. B., in Ex. 226, a covered fifth occurs in the outer voices, which is al. ways more perceptible than between the inner, or one inner and one outer voice. Much must be left to the student's musical intelligence in regard to covered fifths and octaves, for in one case they may be, as here, quite intoler- able, while in another they would not be noticed, owing to different surround- ing voices. The sequence form of chord-succession, as in the following exam- ple, will remove the covered fifths appearing in the aljove. 337. As before, the above examples should be worked out in different keys. It often occurs, where the fundamental rises a fifth or falls a fourth, that the Bass of this second accord takes the tlnird of the fundamental, thus: — 6 338.^'-: 7lt Tzr.. The second accord, according to the figuring here, appears in its Third-Sixth position, and, instead of the fundamental (G) appearing as Bass, its third (B) is taken, which, in the key of C major, is the leading-tone. Witli the pro- gression of the remaining voices over such a Bass, a very common fault arises, e. g. 330. N.B. N.B. The first things noticeable in these examples, arc the oj)en octaves between the Bass and Alto at ct, and between tlie Bass and Tenor at b. These arc of course always inadmissible, but their occurrence in this particular situation gives occasion for special comment. The B, in the Bass, which is here the leading- tone, is doubled at a in the Alto and at b iu the Tenor. The oidy progre.^sion MANUAL OF MUSICAL THFOnV 93 which the leading-tone, as such, can make, is a half-step ujncard to the Tonic, consequently, if the Bass is such a tone, and it is clearly so at X.B. in the above examples, it follows that no doubling of that tone can be allowed, because both voices would require the same progression ujiward to the Tonic, thereby pro- ducing, unavoidably, open octaves. Even if this doubled tone were to be forced into another progression, as at a, Ex. 230, in order to avoid the par- allel octaves, the effect would be the same as before, for the natural progression of this tone is not to be hidden; its proper resolution upward will be heard, as at 6, Ex. 230, producing the octaves, in spite of the forced downward pro- gression: — - , I &. , I 330. f p3E RULE. A tone ivhich has only one fixed progression can never be doubled. The leading-tone in the present case is such an one, and the seventh and bound dissonances in future cases will come under this head. Eemaek. — This is not to say that the seventh degree of the scale, on which the lead- ing-tone occurs, is never to be doubled, but the prohibition is to be observed when that seventh degree shows" its character to be clearly that of a leading-tone ; l c, if the Bass moves upward from the seventh to the Tonic, then that seventh degree is clearly the leading-tone, but if the Bass moves downward then the character- oi the seventh de- gree is not that of a leading-tone. All of the faults shown in Ex's 229 and 230, in- four-isoiaed harmony, may be avoided by doubling the third or sixth of the Bass, when that Bass is the leading-tone, e. g. h. e. ■ , d: , 331. At a, Ex. 231, the connecting tone is G, while the Soprano and Alto pro- gress to G and D, thus doubling the sixth of the Bass, and at b, c and d, the voices progress so that the third of the Bass, viz: D, is doubled. Examples in No. 229 are seen in their corrected form at a and b in Example 231. ELEVATION TO RELATIVE DEGREES BY MEANS OF MAJOR TRIADS. The process here is the same as that used in depi'ession to relative degrees, except that now the fundamental rises a major fifth, or falls a minor fourth, 94 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. gaining one relative degree higher at each progression. Major triads only, are to succeed each other. The following exercises are to be filled out by the pupil. -El 333 ias Ex. 233 is the same with the use of flats. The key of Gj? major has one less flat than the key of Clz major, therefore the chord-succession is elevated one relative degree, and so on back to the key of C major. 333 ite i=l tJ=-,te i?g— tT-^r^ := ELEVATION TO RELATIVE DEGREES BY MEANS OF MINOR TRIADS. The only difference between this and the above is that only minor triads are to appear. ^ $ ^ 334. iJE: :??= * tt2=F=F^f:=1 m Ex. 235 is the same with the use of flats. The key of Eb minor has one less flat than that of Ab minor, therefore the chord-succession is elevated one relative degree, and so on. 335 •Igi 'A b b 's: ^^ ~y^ TRIAD-SUCCESSION IN WHICH THE FUNDAMENTAL RISES OR FALLS A SECOND. Here, the harmonies have no conuectiug tones; hence the. following rules. 1. When the Basa rise.s, all the -other voices should fall. .2. When the Bass falls, all the other voices should rise. If these rules are not carefully followed, in this manner of chord-succession, the worst specimens of parallel octaves and fifths Avill constantly api)ear, such as the following, for example: — 336. I I , I MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 95 Following the rule, however, i. e., causing the upper voices to progress to their i)Iacc.s in the uew accord in contrary motion to the Bass, all these faults disappear, e. g. 337. Cases often occur, where the chords are totally without connecting tones, in Avhich covered fifths sound badly, and are therefore to be avoided, for ex.: — 338. m The covered fifth at a, Ex. 238, may be avoided by doubling the third of the D minor triad, as follows: — 330. The covered fifths at b and c, of Ex. 238, may be avoided by leadin"- the Soprano and Alto upward, thus doubling the sixth of the Bass, as in the fol- lowing examples: — 24.0. ^ ^^ -331 =21 1 It has already been remarked that progressions, which in some cases are not to be tolerated, are in others not only tolerable but agreeable. For instance if the example at a, of 238, were caused to appear in the following manner ' the unpleasant 'effect of the covered fifth would vanish, e. g. =^= 34.1. 1^ 96 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBY. The effect of a progression, therefore, depends largely upon the harrnoniod with which it is placed in connection. No number of rules could cover all the cases, consequently, only the general rule is here given, viz : the progressing upper voices are to move in contrary motion to the Bass, when that voice rises or falls a second. If unpleasant covered octaves or fifths arise, avoid them, either by a different leading of the voices, or by placing the voices differently,or by avoiding the pro- gression altogether. Tlie composer has the matter in his own hand, generally, and is not compelled to make use of a chord-succession which is not capable of acceptable manipulation. PROGRESSION OF THE BASS FROM THE FIFTH TO THE SIXTH DEGREES IN MINOR MODES. This progression, which often occurs, demands a special treatment, for the progression of the upper voices in contrary motion to the Bass does not, in this case, prevent bad voice-leading (see following examples). '^ 34.3. The Tenor, at a in the above example, makes a progression of an augmented ^j^A which is to be avoided as unnielodic, second downward, thus: the same as all augmented and diminished intervals in general. The same fault appears in each of the above examples, and a covered fifth occurs at a and d. This unmelodic progression, together with the covered fifths, is to be avoided by leading the third of the first accord to the third of the second, thus: — 34.3. and the other voices as before. The succession will now be smooth and sing- able, as follows: — •■ 34=4. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 97 When the fundamental falls a second, as in the following examples, the progressing upper voices rise. It will scarcely be necessary to more than merely indicate this method of chord-succession, leaving the student to test tht progressions upon other degrees of major and minor modes. a. b. 34=5. The progression at b, Ex. 245, though showing a covered fifth, between the Soprano and Tenor, in chords not connected, is often found in the works of the best masters. The following still more striking progression, Ex. 246, often occurs in stand- ard works, notwithstanding the very perceptible covered fifth, and the uumel- odic leading of the Alto (G to A^): — 34=6. For vocal purposes, the above passage will be found much more acceptable if the voices are treated as in Ex. 241, thereby avoiding the progression of an augmented second. 34=7". ^ -^- By way of resume, we present a triad-succession in which the Bass moree by seconds, according to the foregoing rules, e. g. 34=8. s Thus far, we have practiced triad-successions upon all the most usable inter- vals in the diatonic scale, i. e., we have learned how to lead the upper voices when the fundanieiital has made the various progressions shown in the follow- ing table: — 98 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 34:9. aso. Second. FuNDAMENTAIi RISES. Third. Fourth. Fifth. Sixth, c^:- ^v 1 ^— a. ^=q .r^ - —^ «^— — 7T ^—\ — ^ : r^ 1 — za 1 — d r 1 f 1 1 : 1 1 1 1 Second. ' 1 FuNDAMENTAIi r.4XL3. Third. Fourth. i 1 FifiJi. Sixth. rx« 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 *-J. ^1 ^ r2 1 . ^ '" f> ^ J, 1 r> sr. — ' CHAPTER XY. FORMATION Of CLOSES. HARMONIC CADENCES OR POINTS OF REST. The foregoing practicing examples are now to be practically applied, first of all, in the construction of closes or cadences. We repeat again that a Jirm, satisfactory close, demands, without exception, that the final accord shall be- gin and end ujyon an accented part of the measure. Further, in all of the following cadences, the most satisfactory arrangement of the voices of the final accord is that in which the Tonic is given to the Bass and Sopi'ano (see a, Ex. 251). That, in which the Soprano has the third (see b, Ex. 251) will be less satisfactory, less firm, and that with the fifth, least so of all, (see c, Ex. 251). The varieties of Cadence or Harmonic points of rest are as follows: — I. Plagal or Half -Cadence. II. Authentic Cadence. III. Complete Cadence. I. The Plagal or Half-Cadence is that in which the closing Tonic-triad is immediately preceded by the triad of the Sub-dominant. ^ b. 351. 353. ( ite isz: m MAyiAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 99 We have already learned that the Snb-doiiiiuuut-triad of a major mode may be iiihior (see pagx- 37). An example of its use is seen at f in Ex. 252. It may not be out of place to repeat here, that while the Sub-domiuant- triad in a major mode may be major or minor at option, that triad in minor modes must always be minor. II. 7%e Authentic Close is that form of cadence in ivhich the final ao- Gord is immediately preceded by the major Dominant-triad, ichether the mode he viajor or minor, e. g. ) ^ ^ c^ - - •■" - cy ^ ass. In minor modes, a chromatic sign will always be necessary, in order to indi- cate the major Dominant-triad, (see h and c, Ex. 253). AUTHENTIC CLOSE WITH SUBSEQUENT SEVENTH. In the Authentic Close, the octave of the fundamental of the Dominant- triad may be followed by the viinor seventh of that fundamental (see N. B. 1, 2 and 3, Ex. 254). Inasmuch as this seventh appears after the balance of the chord has been attacked, we will call it a subsequent seventh, and, being a dUsonance, it is resolved by falling one degree. £5=iii=(:=:gz=:}zsai3 v^ — ^ — ^ — -=-- 1 — - — i—a '1: 254. .is: N.B. 3. /TV ES^^ i=^^i^1 At X. B. 1, Ex. 254, the octave (G) of the fundamenlal is followed by the minor seventh (F) of thsit fundammtal, which resolves itself by falling a degree to the following E. At N. B. 2, the octave (E) is followed by a sub- sequent .-eventh (D), which resolves itself a degree lower to C. In the figur- ing of the same example (h) we make use of a dash ( — ). It signifies sim- ply the repetition or continuance of the corresponding preceding sign; in this case the sharp ^). The G^ in the same example is the leading-tune in the key of A minor, and, as such, should progress to the Tonic (A). The charac- ter of this tone, however, when occurring in a middle voice, as here, is not so distinctly felt; therefore,' in order to make the following accord more complete, it is allowed to progress downward to the fifth of that accord. At X. 1>. 3, Ex. 254, a suhiiejuent seventh (Bjz) follows the octave oi iha fundamental 100 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. (C) i-esolving to the A, one degree lower. The E, in the chord at N. B. 3, is the leading-tone in that key, and, occurring in an outer voice, where its charac- ter is very perceptible, it must progress regularly to the Tonic (F). The G in the Tenor, at the same point, naturally falls to F, and the BI2 must resolve to A; therefore, the final accord appears without the fifth. According to present usage, this is satisfactory even in a closing accord. III. The Complete Cadence is that in lohich are cau.-^ed to appear the Sub- dominant and Dominant-triads, in addition to the Tonic-triad, e. g. N.B. ^ , , N.B. ass. A- ' iS- — ft I L_>5 __l §le: ^- In each of the above examples, the fundamental j^osition of the Tonic- triad occurs three tunes. The cadence will be made more varied and interest- ing if the Fourth-Sixth position of the Tonic-triad be employed at N. B. in- stead of the fundamental, (see N.B. 1 and 2 in Ex. 25G). ase. The Fourth-Sixth accord, occurring in this wise, must ahvays enter upon an accented measural-divmon, and further, it must be followed by a major triad, whose fundamental is the same tone as the Bass of this Fourth-Sixth accord (see N. B. 1, Ex. 256). This is virtually a resolution, {the fourth progresses to the third, and the sixth to the fifth, see figuring) for the chord of the Fourth and Sixth is so dependent, so unstable in itself, that it nearly approaches the character of a dissonant accord, which latter always requires a resolution. In the complete, as well as in the authentic cadence, not only the octave, in the Dominant-triad, but also the fifth, may be followed by a subsequent-seventh, (see b, Ex. 256 and a and b, Ex 257). 'I'lie seventh enters free here; i. e., spring-wise; this can always occur with the minor seventh, it, being such a mild dissonance. 337. 2lp; r :^:=zrJ4^: MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 101 The final accord at a, Ex. 257, is not entirely satisfactory, as a close, ou account of the Soprano having the fifth (C). This occurs because the con- necting tones and natural flow of the voices were strictly observed in the pre- ceding chords. On account of this unsatisfactory final accord, the voices of the Fourth-Sixth accord may be led upward as at N. B., Example h, theroby securing a chord which leads to a firm close upon the Tonic. In the complete close, a Third-Sixth accord can occur upon the Sub-dom- inant, instead of the triad of the Sub-dominant, e. g. N.B. 1. . _ N.B. 2. _ . N.15. 3. S5S. At N. B. 1, Ex. 258, the Third-Sixth position of the D minor triad occurs in place of the usual F major or Sub-domiuaut-triad. At N. B. 2, it is the same position of the diminished triad found on the second degree of the scale in the milder major mode of C (see this triad, page 37). At N. B. 3, it is the same position of the diminished triad found on the second degree in the minor scale. It is this position (Third-Sixth) which we alluded to on page 81, in which the diminished triad sounds most agreeable; the Fundamental and Fourth-Sixth positions are crude and disagreeable. When a Third-Sixth accord follows the Tonic-triad, instead of the Sub-dom- iuant-triad, care must be taken to avoid faulty voice-leading, as at a, Ex. 259. The progression is somewhat improved at 6 in the same example, but as the two chords have no connecting tone, the covered octave is* too perceptible. Leading the Bass in contrary motion, the succession will be correct in every particular, as at c. etc. ?J. I , C. I , /7^ 359. A Third-Sixth accord may follow the triad of the Sub-dominant upon the same Bass in a complete close, as at a, Ex. 260, or this accord may precede the Sub-domiuant-triad, as at &, in the same' example : — 2«0. 102 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. Finally, in the complete close, tiie Sub-dominant and Dominanlrtriads may appear without an intermediate accord. It makes no difTerence which pre- cedes. There being no connecting tones, care is necessary in order to avoid parallel fifths and octaves, and objectionable covered fifths, e. g. N.B. 1. 2GI. At N. B. 1, Ex. 261, the major or minor Sub-dominant-triad may be used optionally; at N. B. 2, the covered fifth is'uot bad, and the F, in the Tenor, could not well progress to Git, in order to avoid the covered fifth, on account of that being an unmelodic step (F — Gjl, an augmented second); at N. B. 3, the last two chords of the preceding example are given in a different form. The covered octave cannot be pronounced bad, as it occurs between an wner and outer voice, and also the Bass, a prominent voice, progresses in contrary mo- tion to the other voices. In the above examples, the Sub-dominaut-triad pre- cedes the triad of the Dominant; in Ex. 262 the position of these triads is re- versed: — 363. lie :?2: '^EE-. TZL -A- is^= m The various kinds of cadence set forth in the foregoing pages slionld be written and played in different keys until their structure is thorouglily uuder- stood. CHAPTER XYI. MODULATION. By the terra Modulation, is to be understood, a harmonic progression, which, starting in any certain key, digresses from that key, approaches a new key and tlierein establishes itself by means of a cadence. For the present examples, the following rule is to be strictly obsei'ved: — In natural, i. c, daf^^ical, modulations, no accord can appear which is not common to the same mode an its immediate j^^ecrding accord. For exam- ple; if the triad of C major appears, then any triad common, t. c, belonging, MANUAL Ox'' MUSICAL THEOEY. 103 to the mode of C major, may follow that C major triad. Thus, we could take uur choice of the following, viz: the A and E minor triads, G and F major, also F minor (the minor Sub-domiiiant-triad), D minor and B diminished, the latter in its Third-Sixth position only. The two triads last mentioned, which are related to the Tonic-triad of C major in a second degree only, should fol- low that accord very rarely. The triads of Ctt major and minor, DI2 major and minor, D major, D|| major and minor, Eb major and minor, E major, Fti major and minor, Gb major and minor, G minor, Gji major and minor, Aj? major and minor, A major, A|^ ma- jor and minor, Bj? major and minor, and B major and minor, could nol follow the triad of C major, because none of these are common to the mode of C major. . Each of them have one or more tones not found in this mode. MAJOR TO PARALLEL MINOR MODES. For the present, we shall confine ourselves to modulations according to the above rule, deferring until a future chapter the discussion of more abrupt pro- gressions, and further, the modulations in the present chapter will be from a certain Tonic-triad (C major) to other keys (A and E minor, F and G major and D minor) whose Tonic-triads are common to the same mode (0 major) First, one of the simplest modulations is that from a major to its parallel mi- nor mode, for example, from C major to A minor. The Tonic-triads of these two modes are so closely related that they may follow each other, e. g. 363. i w ^§!E: i^: Having reached the neio Tonic-triad (A minor), the next point is to estdb- lish the new key by means of a cadence. Adding the complete close, the most satisfactory of all, to the foregoing example (Ex. 263), the modula- lion from C major to A minor will be complete, e. g. 364. < n -A.* i 1 Cadence. 1 1 /r\ \i ^ A<^- f>: «/ -% _^ ?^ - % m^ -% ' ^ if'* J . X.B. 1.' N.B. 2. 6 5 ' it n\ Ck* 1 1 ►-J.VW ' 1 /^ ^ X J ir^^ ' ^ riy • Note. — The large capital indicates the major, ami the small capital, the raiuor triad the letters here (C — A) imply a modulation from C major to A minor. Th«8; 104 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOET. At N F». 1, Ex. 264, the new Tonic-triad first appears, followed, at N. B. 2, by the Suh dominant-triad of the new key and the remainder of the com- 2)lete clo.ie in that key, thus firmly establishing the key of A minor. The above modulation may be made more interesting by introducing, between the second and tliird accords, the relative-third triad below A, viz : F major. The first four harmonies will then be connected by two tones each, as the fun- damental falls a third at each progression, e. g. 3«5. As before, the new Tonic-triad appears at N. B. 1, Ex. 265, and the new Sub-dominant-tr'iad at N. B. 2, with the F major triad inserted between them. The incompleted upper voices should be filled out by the pupil. A tliird form, Ex. 266, shows that it is not always necessary to reach the new Tonic-triad previous to the appearance of the new Sub-dominant-triad, (seeN. B).' C— A. 360. A fourth form of this modulation (C — a) is seen in Ex. 26"?:- 36y. N.B. 1. N.B. 2 As the new Sub-dominant-triad (D minor) is common to the mode of C ma- jor, that triad can follow the C major triad immediately, as at N. B. 1, Ex. 267, or, as we have already learned, a Third-Sixth accord can occur upon tlio same Bass (I)) instead of the Sub-dominant-triad (sec parenthesis, N. B. 2). Care is always necessary in order to avoid faulty voice-leading in chords not eoHiu^ctcd, like the above. In the measure next to the last, a subscqueut- seventh is made use of. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 105 From the foregoing "\ve are able to establish the two rules or methods of procedure, following: — 1. Starting with any chosen key, the modulation is to proceed or digress from that key and approach the new key by means of connected accords (i. e., common to the same mode). Having reached the new Tonic-tnad, cause its Sub-dominant-triad to follow. The Bass of this triad is then to 7'he one xohole step, and upon this new tone a Fourth-Sixth accord is to appear. This is the Jieio Tonic-triad in its Fourth-Sixth position, therefore it is major or minor 2lc- cordiuu- to whichever that triad is to be. The Fourth-Sixth accord is then to be fol- lowed, be it major or minor, by a rnq/or-triad v^ho&Q fundamental is the same tone as the Bass of that Fourth-Sixth accord. This major-triad is the new Domi- nant-triad in its Fundamental position, and leads directly to the same position of the Tonic-triad of the new key. 2. The new Sub-dominant-triad may be sometimes gained (see Ex. 267) by these natural means (connected accords) before the new Tonic-triad shows itself. The process following the attainment of the new Sub-domiuant-triad is as before, "The Bass rises a whole step," etc. (see above). The new Tonic-triad, in these cases, appears in its Fundamental position only in the final accord. The rhythm of the modulation must be so arranged that the Fourth-Sixth accord shall invariably enter upon an accented part of the measure (see this chord in the above examples.) Modulations should be now attempted from various major to their parallel minor modes, for instance from G — e, E — c^, Di? — b!? etc, following the method above rehearsed and the models set forth in Examples 264 — 7. It will also be found excellent practice to name the different triads, with their positions, necessary to effect any chosen modulation. MINOR TO PARALLEL MAJOR MODES. Having considered modulations from a major to its parallel minor mode, its reverse will very naturally follow, viz: from a minor to its parallel major, for example, from A minor to C major. Being closely related, the two Tonic-triads may follow each other, succeeded by the complete cadence to C major, e. g. 368. In the present modulation, the new Sul)-dominaut-triad may follow the A minor triad, or a Third-Sixth accord may appear upon the same Bass, as in the parenthesis. Ex. 269. 106 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. seo. Practice in various keys sliould here follow. The following- exercise will serve as a resume of the modulations from a major to its parallel minor mode and vice versa. Ab — F. F — Ah. syo. Antithenis- The above is simply two modulations united, with the rhythm so arranged as to fulfill all the conditions of a well-ordered musical period, with its divisions and sub-divisions of thesis, antithesis and sections. All the modulations which the pupil may have worked out from a major to its parallel minor, and the re- verse, may now be united in a similar manner to Ex. 270. Though somewhat difficult to accomplish, it will be all the better if the exercises are rhythmi- cally ordered, and, to this end, see that the thesis and antithesis contain the same number of measures, also that the sections are of equal length, and that the rhythm of each section is similar to that in the others. Be sure that the Fourth-Sixth accord falls upon an accented part of the measure. The reverse of the modulation shown in Ex. 270, should now be attempted, viz: from a minor to its parallel major mode and back, e. g. ct-E.^ E-ci ; ^ I I /V\ 371." §i||b^^ S^^f^gg It will be seen from Examples 210 and 271, that the rhythmic motion can be produced in various ways. It is not necessary that the Bass, any more than any other voicCs, shall continually follow the rhythm. If more rhythmic MANUAL Oh' MUSICAL THEOBT. 107 motion is at any time desired than the Bass already presents, it can 1)o gained very easily by causing the upper voices to spring to another position of the same chord, as at N. B. 1, Ex. 271, or making use of two diflferent chords up- on the same Bass, as at N. B. 2 and 3 of Ex. 271, or by a subsequent-seventh, as in the last measm-e but one of Ex. 270. At N. B. 2, Ex. 271, the Third- Sixth accord enters spring-wise. The privilege was used here to prevent the false voice-leadings which would have occurred in the succeeding progression, had the Third-Sixth accord been connected with its preceding accord (A ma- jor). The following example shows what the result might have been: — c« ~E. J^ 1^ J I I I S73, 3E!B^ Sifc: 6 4 MAJOR TO ITS RELATIVE THIRD ABOVE. Commencing with C major, this modulation will be to E minor. The .new Sub-dominant-triad (A minor, see N. B., Ex. 273) being common to the mode of C major, that accord can follow immediately, and with the remainder of the complete close, the new key (E minor) will be firmly established, e. g. C— E. 6 ^ ays iS! 22: KB. Ex. 274 shows the reverse of the above, the modulation from a minor to that major mode situated a major third below, for example, from A minor to F major. 2'7^.< '--w --W- -g- iie: 6 4 5 3 -i9- The Bass,in the first two measures of Ex. 274, is not melodic. The A and Bl? (see dotted line) do not stand in a melodic relation to each other, and the note between (D), does not remove the objection. It is to be avoided by taking the A an octave lower, as in Ex. 275, which is melodic with both D and Bb. A— F. 6 4 5 3 /T\ 1 ' .*'. 1 975 T'rf^ ''■■ , 1 r '^ 1 -«S 4 ^- ^ I J .1 '-^ \}/-2 r> 1 r> /'>' 1 108 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBY. If a composition is to be made natural and flowing, not only each two, but each three or more notes, according to circumstances, should have a melodic connection. The mind and voice of the vocalist perceives and attacks each succes- sive note by placing that in connection with one or more of its preceding notes. Of course the difficulty of attack is increased in proportion as the melodic ele- ment is wanting. Neither of the note-connections at a and h of Ex. 2*16, can be regarded as melodic, it makes no difference in which voice they might occur. They are improved at c and d of the same example: — Faidtv. Better, a. ■ .(2Z. ^*^ ^- "^"^ ^^. ^"^ c. d. zsr 376. :sz: Modulations from a major to the minor mode, a relative third above, and back, should now follow, for example; from C major to E minor and back; F major to A minor and ])ack, etc. Then the modulation should be reversed, for example: from E minor to C major and back; A minor to F major and back, etc. The models given in Ex's. 270 and 2*11 are to be referred to. MODULATION TO THE SUB-DOMINANT. Beginning, as before, with the key of C major, the modulation will be to F major. The new Tonic-triad being common to the mode from which we start, it can follow immediately, as at jST. B. 1, Ex. 2tt. The new Sub-dominant- triad (N. B. 2) and the remainder of the complete cadence to F major finish the modulation, e. g. C— F, a:: 13?: N.B.l. N.B.2. Ex. 218 shows a very similar process in modulating from a minor to the mode of its Sub-dominant, which is of course minor also. A — D. b 6 4 5 It /TN C^' f — /!>— i^ .. __;?__I1^_ 1 3r8.->^-p. — \ \ — ' !^~~~\ -1 1 - ^ 1 -J ^ r^ 1 N.B. 1. N.B. 2. N.B. 3. The new Tonic appears at N. B. 1, the new Sub-dominant at N. B. 2, and the new Dominant at N. B. 3. The latter, according to our rule for modula- tion, must be a major triad, in minor as well as in major modes, therefore the .chromatic sign (■ji). MODULATION TO THE DOMINANT OR FIFTH. For example, from C major to G major. The Tonic-triad of the com- mencing key (C major) is at the same time the Sub-dominaut-triad of the new MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. ]^Qg key (G major). All that is necessary to complete this modulation, is there- fore to add the remainder of the usual cadence, e. g. C— G. 6 5 1 « "^ .§ie: aro.^^fcrza: The above is to be repeated concerning this modulation in minor modes, for example, from A minor to E minor: — A— E. r, A 6 ^7 380 iis ~-£C t9- In Ex. 280, as the first chord is already the new Sub-dominant-triad, we make use here also of the Third-Sixth accord which may always appear upon the Sub-dominant in a cadence. The intervals of this Third-Sixth accord must always be arranged according to the new key, in the cadence of which it oc- curs, and not according to the preceding key. In the above example, there- fore, this accord cannot appear (in classical modulations) as A, C, F, but as A, C, r||, because in the Jiew key (E minor) the letter F is sharped. TONIC TO SUB-DOMINANT AND BACK. Modulations may now be formed from any Tonic to its Sub-dominant (ma- jor or minor) by the process described in Examples 2T7 and 278, and then from that Sub-dominant back to the Tonic, this latter being the same as a modula- tion from a Tonic to its Dominant (a fifth upward), a process described in Ex's. 219 and 280. Arrange the exercise similar to No. 270; then reverse the modulation, viz: from a Tonic to its Dominant and back. TONIC TO ITS SECOND. Thus far, the modulations have been from a Tonic to the nearest related keys, viz: to the relative thirds below and above, and to the Sub-dominant and Dominant. There still remain two triads common to the same mode, but more distantly related. They are situated upon the second and seventh degrees of the major scale, but only one, that on the second degree, can be used as the Tonic-triad of a new key, the other being a dissonant triad. The modulation from a Tonic to its second, for example, from C major to D minor, requires a few remarks. The neio Sub-dominant (G) is a tone common to the mode of C major,and, at first thought, it would appear that the new Sub-dominant-i?'iaG? could suc- ceed the commencing chord, as at N. B., Ex. 281. no MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. C— D. 381. The first two chords, m the above example, are rightly connected, but the second and third, (G major and D minor) are not. The accord at N. B. is a major triad, whereas the Su1)-dominaut-triad in the cadence to a minor mode must be minor. Supposing, however, that this triad be made minor by flat- ting its third (B), as follows :- 383. ilB: ZSl is: *the fault would only be removed to another [dace, not avoided, for now the 'first and second chords are not properly connected. Our rule sets forth that each chord (in classical rnodulations) viust he common to the same mode as its immediate preceding accord. In the above example, the G minor triad can not immediately follow the C major, because it is not common to the mode of iC major. The difiSculty can be overcome in the following manner: — ,N.B. , I 383. ;A.t N. B. of Ex. 283, the G major triad is converted into G minor by means ■of a chromatic alteration of the third. The chord-succession is now correct, (see following rule). CROSS RELATION. Wherever it may be deemed advantageous, as it certainly was in the fore- going case, a major accord may he concerted into a minor, or a minor into a major, by chromatically altering its third, hut this alteration must take place in the same voice, otherwise a Cross Relation arises, as in the following ex- amples; — 3-8 A. pT^^^P^E^P^ 5^; MAXUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Ill At a, Ex. 284, the G major accord is converted into G minor, bnt the tone to be altered (B), mstead of remaining in the Soprano, passes to the Tenor. At b, c and d, are similar examples, the altered tone appearing each time in a different voice. The effect of these chord-successions is strangely disjointed ; the cause of this effect is simply that the rule for voice-leading is transgressed. Here, in each example, are two different accords; at a, they are G major and G minor. Our rule says that those tones common to both accords, if there be any, shall be retained in the same voices. The D and G, of the first accord at a, should be retained in the second accord as Tenor and Alto, instead of springing to Blz and D ; then the Soprano (B) of the first accord need only progress to B[2 (see a, Ex. 285). To the rule above given, we may now add that all or any tones to be chromatically altered, in connected accords, must receive that alteration in the same voice. According to these rules, the chord-successions shown in Ex. 284, are cor- rectly written as follows: — 385. I w m 'w I ^ ■'^^. t=t=c=i==t-. SECOND TO THE TONIC. Here follows the reverse of Ex. 283 ; i. e., a modulation from the triad on the second degree of the major scale back to the Tonic; for example, from D minor to C major. The new Sub-dominant-triad (F major) is closely related to the commencing key ; that, and the cadence, can therefore immediately fol- low, e. g. -C. I , ^ SS6. ^ is: N.B. I pEi ZSE. Note. — The letters underneath (the fundamentals of each accord) are placed here for the sake of comparison with those of Examples 287 and 288. Instead of the triad of the new Sub-dominant (F, A, C), a Third-Sixth accord (F, A, D) can appear upon the Sub-dominant which is the triad of D minor in its Third-Sixth position, (see N. B, Ex. 287). 112 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. asy. D— c. KB. 22: "sr (5 3 zzr. ate 1221 G C. No change of harmony is apparent here, in the first two measures, only a change of position of the same harmony (see fundamentals). The Third-Sixth accord is then followed by the new Tonic-triad in its Fourth-Sixth position, the same as in previous cadences. FREE ENTRANCE OF THE FOURTH-SIXTH ACCORD. If the C major Fourth-Sixth accord can succeed the D minor triad in its Third-Sixth position, it can also succeed that triad in its Fundamental position, thus omitting the Third-Sixth accord, used in Ex. 287, thus: — / 388. Heretofore, all the voices of the Fourth-Sixth accord have entered and pro- gressed degree-wise; here,' the Bass enters sjjring-wise; hence, the entrance is said to be free; i. e., abrupt, without connection. It is to be remarked that the succession is much better if the Bass (D) ascend to G, rather than descend to the G in parenthesis, on account of securing contrary motion, and tlie avoidance of a covered octave. It is rarely advisable that all the voices move in similar m(v tion. The placing of the voices of the minor triad, used in the last example, is also to be considered, for, while some are usable, others must be rejected. We present iu the following example (No. 289) the varied arrangement of the voices, close and open, in such a chord-succession as that in Ex. 288. Those at a, b and d are usable, and those at c, e and / must be rejected on account of the consecutive fifths. not. not. not. b. e. _,o._ _. d. e. f. , 289. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 113 Examples 283 and 288 may now be united in a modulation from a Tonic to its second and back. See that the rhythm, in all these united modulations, is suitable one to the other. Thus, in Ex. 283, the rhythmic motion, in the first measure, is expressed in half-notes, while in the corresponding measure in Ex. 288, there is a whole-note. The rhythm in these two measures may be made aUke by dividing the whole-note into half-notes, and, as the chord iu the first measure of Ex. 283 changes the position of its voices, progressing them all downward, so, also, the resemblance will be stronger in Ex. 288, if the chord in its first measure, after being divided into half-notes, make a similar progression downward, (see N. B. 1 and 2, Ex. 290). C— D. D— C. 390. This completes the directions upon modulation from a given Touic-triad to the Tonic-triads of other keys common to the same mode. It is only neces- sary to repeat that the surest means of firmly fastening these modulations in both mind and fingers, is to write and play them in all keys in both close and open position of the harmonies. In addition to this, it will be found excellent practice for the pupil to name the chords and their positions, necessary to ef- fect any chosen modulation. The pupil is thus doubly or triply grounded in the process. / CHAPTER XYII. MODULATiaNS TO MORE DISTANT KEYS. We shall consider, in this chapter, modulations between two keys, whose Tonic-triads are not common to the same mode; for example, from C major to Bl2 major and vice versa; C major to Ei? major and vice versa, etc. Accord- ing to principles explained on pages 90, 91 and 94, a chord-progression is de- pressed one relative degree when the fundamental falh a major fifth, or it is elevated one relative degree when the fundamental rises a major fifth. In this present species of modulation, it is first of all to be decided whether the new key is to be reached by depression or elevation, one, two or three relative degrees, (for a greater number than three, a special process will be duly ex- plained). If the new key has more flats or less sharps in its signature than the commencing key, then the process is depression. If the new key has less flats or more sharps, then it is elevation. The process of modulation here, is simply as follows: The fundamental falls or rises a major fifth each time 114 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. until the new Tonic-triad or new Sub-dominant-triad is gained. The new key is then to be established according to the method with which we are al- ready familiar, viz: by a complete cadence. FROM C MAJOR TO MAJOR KEYS WITH FLATS AND RETURN. To illustrate this, we will commence with a modulation from C major to B|2 major. The new key {V>\i) having more flats than the commencing key (C), the process is depression, henoe, the fundamental falls a major fifth to F, and as the triad of C was major, so also the triad of F will be major, (see Ex. 291). 391. iie The modulation is now depressed one relative degree, and neither the new- Tonic nor new Sub-dominant-triad have as yet appeared, so the fundamental (F) falls again a major fifth, to Bj?, and here appears the new Tonic-triad (see N. B. 1, Ex. 292). At N. B. 2 the new Sub-dominant-triad follows and the remainder of the cadence establishing the key of Bjz major, e. g. 'C-Bb. 3»3. The returning modulation (Bb — C) may be effected in the following manner. The new key having less flats than the commencing key, the process is through elevation. The fundamental (Bl?) therefore ri^es a major fifth to F (one rel- ative degree above Bjz) which is already the new Sub-dominant. Upon it a major accord appears, followed immediately by the Fourth-Sixth position of the new Tonic-triad and the remainder of the cadence to C major, e. g. Bb— C. ao3. The principles applied in the last two examples (292, 293) are now to be employed in a modulation from C major to Eb major and back, one relative degree farther removed. The process is precisely the same as in Ex. 292, only the MANUAL OF MVSICAL THEORY. 115 fundamental falls three relative degrees before the new Tonic is gained (see N. B. 1, Ex. 294). The cadence then follows (new Sub-dominant at N. B. 2), The upper voices should be filled out by the pupil : — C—Eb. b bo \A 3 h 394. §i^= is =^ -^ N.B. 1. K.B. 2. The return modulation (Ei? — C) is eifected by elevation, three relative de- grees, similar to Ex. 293. The fundamental rises each tune a major fifth until the uew Sub-dominant (F) is reached (N. B, Ex. 295). The remainder of the cadence immediately follows, e.g. Eb-C. h U_ ^4 3^ 395 .^•f^=i^ N.B. DEPRESSION FOUR RELATIVE DEGREES. The modulation from C major to AI2 major, which is one relative degree still farther removed, could also be effected in the same manner as the forego- ing, viz : the fundamental would fall to F, then BI2, E|2 and A\i, the last of which, being the new Tonic, would be followed by the cadence. There is a shorter and more interesting way, in which the modulation cap be depressed four relative degrees at once. This occurs when a major triad is succeeded by its minor Sub-dominant-triad. As the keys of C major and Ai? major are four relative degrees apart, we can make use of this method of modulation here. The C major accord will therefore be followed by its minor Sub-domin- aat-triad, thus: — S96. The key of F minor (the parallel key of Al? major), whose signature has four flats, therefore four relative degrees below C major, is thus reached in one step. Having reached a triad common to the new mode, the new Tonic-triad or the new Sub-domiuant-triad may next follow. The new Sub-dominant (Df?) is situated a major third below F, and a triad upon this tone, followed by the remainder of the complete cadence, will establish the new key (Ab major), e. g. C—Ah. 39r. 116 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. The modulation from X\> major back to C major vrill be an elevation of four relative degrees. Related in the third to A)?, is the triad of F minor, which can be used as the Sub-dominant-triad of C major, the new key, e. g. Ab— C. b5 b fl6 5 4 3 l-Ts '\<\^ C\' ^ a 1 399. *-l.iv 1 -^ \ J <^ \ \ From C major to Dj? major is a depression of five relative degrees. We can first depress the modulation one degree, and then four, or vice versa, or by single degrees, as we choose. If the modulation is first depressed four de- grees, it is effected the same as in Ex. 291, by taking the minor Sub-dominaat- triad of a major accord (see first measure, Ex. 299). The new Tonic-triad (Dl?) can then follow, being related in the third to F minor. The new Tonic being gained, nothing remains but to establish it by means of the usual ca- dence, e. g. C— Dtr. t, U 1?^ U*^ 1?^ U 7 Vb , I, Vi t 3 175 7^. \ 1 \?% 1 -—VIS' 1 T The return modulation (D|7 — C), an elevation of five relative degrees, ac- complished by single degrees is long and monotonous. Corresponding to the depression of four relative degrees at one progression, we have a means of ele- vation the same number of degrees, viz : when a minor triad is succeeded by its major Dominant-triad. The first point is to" secure the minor accord. Related in the third, below every major triad, there is a minor triad. lu the present modulation (Db — C, Ex. 300) the Dl? triad is major, therefore, we taiiz: 1. Depression four relative degrees results wKen a major triad is followed by its minor Sub-dominant-triad. 2. Elevation four relative degrees results when a minor triad is followed by its major Dominant-triad. FROM C MAJOR TO MAJOR KEYS WITH SHARPS AND RETURN. Modulations from the Normal mode to all keys with sharps, should now be attempted. They are effected in the same manner as the foregoing, except that the progression y/"o??i C major is elevation, and that toward C (the return modulation) is depression. ■ An example or two will clear away any apparent difficulty; for instance, from C major to E major. The process is by elevation, four relative degrees at once. Related to the C major triad is that of A minor, which can be used as the minor Sub-dominant-triad to E major. The rest of tlie cadence follow.'* and the modulation is completed, e. y. $ i^zz: The return modulation (E — C) may be accomplished thus: depress four relative degrees by following the E major triad with its minor Sub-dominant- triad (A, C, E). The new Sub-dominant-triad (F, A, C,) can then follow witk the cadence to C major. 303. s^^^^^p^ From C major to F|| major is an elevation of six relative degrees. We pass over four by gaining a minor triad and succeeding it with its major Domi- nant-triad (see first three chords in Ex. 303). The fundamental (E) then rises one relative degree to B, which is the Sub-dominant of the new key. In the cadence of Fj|, the elevation of the last degree of the six takes place, e. g. :s ^ $ $ c-Fjf. j_ #_ ^ i i 303. g^e^=^ ^- =gj^F^^=^ The return (F'^ — C) is by depression. The F|i major is followed by its minor Sub-dominant-triad (B, D, F^', thus accomplisliing /bt/r of the six de- grees depression. The fundamental (B) then falls a fifth to E, upon which a m inor triad must appear. 118 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Rule. — Whenever the fundamental of a minor triad falls a major fifth, hath accords must he minor, {in minor the sub-dominant triadmnstheminor). Related in the third to E* minor, is the new Tonic-triad, C major. The ca- dence then follows, e. g. F«-C. J J 5 -65 304.^I^=|^-^^ ^^P 3 The earnest pupil will work out and play the modulations from C major to each one of the other major keys with sharps and back to C major. All the principal connecting triads between these keys are thereby learned. MODULATIONS FROM KEYS WITH FLATS TO THOSE WITH SHARPS AND VICE VERSA. From keys with flats to those with sharps, the modulation is by elevation; from sharps to flats, depression. To learn the number of degrees between the two keys, it is only necessary to add the number of flats and sliarps in both signatures together. Eemaek. — No signature will be used in the following examples, the triads being sufficient to represent the mode. The use of the signature here would be of no jDrac - tical value ; on the contrary, it would necessitate a great number of accidentals. In the first modulation (F — G, one flat to one sharp), an elevation of two relative degrees, the fundamental (F) rises a major fifth to C, which is al- ready the new Sub-dominant. The rest of the cadence completes the mod- ulation, e. g. F-G. >05.ilB= -I From G major to F major is a depression of two relative degrees. The fundamental falls a major fifth twice, thereby reaching the new Tonic (F) which is then established by the cadence. G— F. 6 5 306 §s 22: =^ From Biz major to D major is an elevation of four relative degrees. Rela^ ted in the third to Bk is the triad of G minor which can be used as the minor Sub-dominaut-triad to the new key. Bb-D. 307 aiB: -k. -4-e>. 1-^- MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 119 The return from D major to Et? major is a depression of four relative de- grees. The four degrees may be passed over iu one step by taking the minor Sub-dominant-triad of D major (G minor). The new Sub-dominant-triad then hes a major third lower (Eb). Cadence. D-Bb. ^ b\ 308. ^ From Elz major to A major is an elevation of six relative degrees. An ele- vation of four degrees may be effected by following a minor triad with its mar jor Dommant-triad. Related in the third to Eb major, is the triad of C minor; this may be followed by its major Dominant-triad (Gr, B, D), thus accom- plishing the four degrees. The fundamental (G) of this triad then rises a fifth to D, which is the new Sub-dominant. Cadence. Et-A. I,, J I. 309 iiE :=2fc -;^= The contrary modulation (A — Eb) is a depression of six degrees. Four of these may be passed over by following the A major triad with its minor Sub- dominant-triad (dTfTa The fundamental (D) then falls a fifth to G upon which a minor triad must appear, (see rule, page 118). Related in the third to this triad (G minor), is that of the new Tonic (Ei?). Cadence. A— Eb. # ^ ^ ^' h \>\ 310 §ie= ■^ -}s^st. ^ fe: The remaining modulations, viz: — Ab — E and back, Db — B and back, Gb— Fj( and back, Cb— C^ and back, can now be worked out by the pupil, with the aid of the foregoing examples. A few words, however, respecting that from Gb major to Fjj: major and back, may be opportune. Thus far, we have confined ourselves exclusively to modulations with the em- ployment of the most natural chord-connections, according to the strictest classical rules. The Gb major and F|[ major, therefore, cannot be considered as one and the same key, here; the enharmonic change is not allowed. These two keys stand twelve relative degrees apart, and the modulation must pass over this long distance, in the same manner as all those preceding, as follows. 120 MANUAL OF IfUSICAL THEOBT. \st. Elevate four relative degrees by following the El? minor triad (related ill the_third to the commencing key, Gb major) with its major Dominant triad (h\l, D, F). 'ind. Elevate four degrees more by following the relative minor triad of Bl? major (Gr minor) with its major Dominant-triad (D major), od. Re- lated in the third to D major is the B minor triad which is the minor Su1> dominant-triad to the new key. Cadence. 311 ^E. 1 \ b # =r. rsr^^ te The return modulation (Fij; — Gj?) may be effected in the following manner. \st. The Fli major triad may be followed by its minor Sub-dominant-triad (B, D, F|:f), thus gaining four of the twelve degrees depression. 2nd'. In or- der to accomplish the next four degrees, we must first secure a major accord, and follow it with its minor Sub-dominant-triad. Related to B minor in the thii'd, is the G major triad; its minor Sub-dominaut-triad (C minor) now fol- lows, thus accomplishing the second four degrees. 3c?. We may now proceed by single relative degrees, the fundamental of the C minor triad being caused' to fall a fifth to F, upon which a minor triad must appear (see rule page 118) and then again to Bb minor. Related in the third to Bb minor is the new Tonic (Gb major). Cadence, e. g $ $ h , bs bo be bs bs 312.1 ?iB= + \ b h 3 re: ■t}^ =r^ ^ :bs: -b^* — Modulations from minor to major modes, major to minor, and minor to min- or, have been omitted until now. They will present no especial difficulty if the following points are well-remembered. 1. Every minor triad has a major triad upon its relative-third below. 2. The Sub-dominant-triad of a minor mode must always be minor. 3. A major triad can always be converted into a minor by depressing its third a small half-step. We present here a few examples: — F minor to G major, an elevation of five relative degrees. Four degrees are accomplished by following the F minor with its Dominant-triad (C major). This is at once the Sub-doniinant-triad of the new key, e. g. G. 313.: -H- + The return (G — f) is a depression of five degrees. The fundamental (G/ MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 121 falls one degree to C, and then four to F minor, which is the new Tonic. Ca- dence, e. g. * G— r. b b 314. p^^ br. 4 35^- 3z: From Bb minor to D major is an elevation of seven degrees. The Domi- nant-triad to Bb minor (F, A, C), elevates the modulation four degrees. The fundamental of this triad (F) then rises a fifth to C, then again to G, which is the new Sub-dominant, e.g. 313 iiEg -<2- ziSi ^it-^il- Returning from D major to Bb minor is a depression of seven degrees. The I) major accord may be followed by. its minor Sub-dominant-triad (G, Bb, D), accomplishing four degrees. Related in the third to G minor, is the triad of Eb major. This may be converted into the new Sub-dominant-triad by flat- ting its third (G), for, according to the invariable rule, a minor mode demands a minor Sub-dominant-triad. Cadence, e. g. D-Ek. 316 ias # > i-t 5!2 + * The fore;goiug examples suflBciently illustrate modulations from minor to major modes, and major to minor. The following examples are modulations from minor to minor. From Ab minor to C|| minor, is an elevation of eleven relative degrees. We pass over four degrees by following Ab minor with its major Dominant- triad (Eb, G Bb). In order to accomplish the next four degrees in one pro- gression, we must first secure a minor accord. Related in thfe third to Eb major is the triad of C minor, which we follow with its major Dominant (G, B, D). The remaining three degrees will be passed over singly, therefore, WxQ fundamental (G) rises a degree to D, then to A. Related in the third to A major, is the new Sub-dominant (FJJ! minor). Cadence, e. g. Abr— C«. b^b^L. W i), %. ^ ^ $ ^ ■'^•IzSa - i 1- 3^ ^ The return modulation (c^ — Ab) is a depression of eleven degrees. 1. To pass over four degrees we must first gain a major accord. Related in the third to C|| minor is the triad of A major, which we follow with its minor Sub- dominant-triad (D, F, A). 2. Related to this in the third, is the Bb major 122 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. triad; its minor Sub- dominant-triad (E^, Gb, Bl?) following, depresses the modulation four degrees more. 3. One degree below this, the new Tonic ap- pears. Cadence, e. g. fit b^ b5 b^ be bs b5 ... mm^^^^^^^^ ^ -^ % :b^ CHAPTER XYIII. SUCCESSION OF TRIADS NOT COMMON TO THE SAME MODE. Thus far, we have carefully observed the rule for classical chord-succession; i. e., each successive accord is found common to the mode of the accord im- mediately preceding. Romantic music, however, makes use also of accords immediately succeeding each other which do not occur in the same mode. If such striking chord-successions are to be employed, the following rules must be observed: — I. Avoid ininatural voice-leading. II. Avoid unkarmonic crons-relations. III. Retain similar tones, if there be any, in the same voices. TV: Wherever possible, avoid even covered fifths and octaves. If the leading of each individual voice is smooth and natural, the chord- succession (in modern music) is correct. If, however, the voice-leading is obliged to make use of unnatural progressions, in order to accomplish an at- tempted chord-succession, it must be rejected. By unnatural progressions, we mean here the progression of any voice an augmented or diminished interval, as for example: — 319. itziSi*^ iiv 2V By natural progressions is therefore to be understood, major and minor in- tervals, so that if each voice can progress to its place in the new accord with the use of major or minor intervals, and not transgress the above rules, then the chord-succession may be pronounced correct. In Ex. 320, at a, the chord- succession is incorrect on account of the unnatural voice-leading in the Soprano (E — Db, an augmented second, see Rule I). In Ex. 320, b, the voice-leading is all by means of natural progressions, but Rules II and III are disregarded, and a cross-relation appears between the Tenor and Soprano. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY, a. \ faulty. \ b. , faulty. 123 330. m * Z^- "We present below examples of the manner in which varions Tonic-triads may succeed the Tonic-triad of C major. 3ai. <^ C— c. C— Db. C-D. C-E|j. C— Eb. C— E. C-F$. C— g. C — B. C — B. At a in the ahoxe example, the chromatic alteration is effected in the same voice (Tenor), thereby avoiding the cross-relation presented in Ex. 320. At 6, the Soprano progresses a minor second upward (E — F) instead of an aug- mented second downward (E — Db), as in Ex. 320, At g, the Bass makes an unnatural progression (C to A|f, a diminished third below). This, chord-succes- sion is sometimes used, in spite of the fault alluded to. The chord-succession at h, sounds disagreeably, by itself, because the' Dominant-triad of a major mode should be major. In connection with other harmonies, as at i, the same succession is perfectly acceptable, because the G is no longer reckoned as the Dominant to C, but as the second degree in the mode of F, in which G minor is to be found. At^, we present a similar example to that at h, and it will be remarked that the major triad upon Bb, after F minor, sounds harshly because a minor mode demands a minor Sub-dominant-triad. The same succession at k, however, is quite correct, because the F minor is now reckoned as a triad on the second degree in the mode of Et? major, and not a Tonic-triad, as a.tj. 124 MAJVUAL OF MUSICAL TUEORF. The BI? triad is now the Dominant-accord to El? major, therefore, necessarily major. At m, a cross-relation occurs between C of the Bass and C^ of the Soprano. This is one of the few instances in which frequent use has rendered such a fault tolerable. This succession often occurs. At p, the augmented second (C — Djt) in the Alto, though often used, may be avoided by doubling the third of the first chord, as at g. The covered fifths in the last two ex- amples have also been heard so often that they no longer excite comment. The foregoing are only a small part of the possible number of snch chord- successions, for the progressions may be from — Major to Major; Major to Minor; Minor to Major; Minor to Minor. Following the observations already made, no great difficulty will be experi enced in accomplishing all, and in selecting from the number those which are suitable for practical use, and in rejecting those which are not. In ail such as are suitable for practical purposes, i. e., not too abrupt, an inner connection will be found between the harmonies, though outwardly they may appear quite foreign. For instance, in the example at 6, No. 321, the two triads, C and Dl? major, appear outwardly to have nothing in common with each other,- yet this inner connection referred to, will be apparent at once, if F minor be regarded as the mode, for in this mode l)oth of the above-mentioned triads are found, e. g. 333. Both triads at c, Ex. 321, are common to the mode of G major. Again, at d, the inner connection is not so intimate, yet enough so for practical use. The triads of C major and C minor are certainly closely related, and the triad of El? major is common to the mode of C minor, e. g. 333. Wb /z: m. z:l22= The most abrupt of all the progressions given is seen at g, Ex. 821. The inner connection, though distant, is to be traced in the following example : — 334. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 125 Oil the contrary, such a succession as that in Ex. 325, is too abrujit for practical use, as the connection is too far removed; the covered fifths are also bad here. This, and simihir progressions, although the voices may be led ac- cording to the foregoing rules and observations, are therefore to be rejected. 335. CHAPTER XIX. DISSONANT TRIADS. THE DIMINISHED TRIAD. The diminished triad (so-called because next smaller than a minor triad), a dissonant accord, is composed of o. fundamental, its minor third and minor fifth. Its dissonance, which is the minor fifth or its inversion, the major fourth, is so mild that the entrance of this triad requires no preparation. \A tone is prepared tvhen it ha^ appeared in the same voice as a component part of the preceding chord. A chord is prepared when one or more of its tones have thus appeared. Bjfree entrance is meant the reverse of this; {i. e., no pre- vious appearance of any tone or tones is required). As A DISSONANCE IS THE MELODIC RETARDATION OF A CONSONANCE, SO, OUe Or both of the tones {fundamental and fifth) forming the dissonance in the dim- inished triad must progress degree-wise into a consonance. This resolution may take place downward or upward ; either is correct so long as a co7i.laced in several different ways, but the third must always be doubltd in hannonies of four or more voices. 331. 128 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. In the following example (a), the Aqgmented-Sixth accord enters free, and does not appear to resolve itself regularly, as in the previous examples, inas- much as the Fourth-Sixth position of the triad of C major follows immediately, instead of the triad of G major. The Fourth-Sixth accord here, as in gen- eral, is but a retardation, so to speak, of another triad in its Fundamental position upon the same Bass, as in complete cadences. The resolution of the Augmented-Sixth accord is simply retarded, but appears correctly in the Gr major triad following, the Fourth-Sixth accord having been interpolated for variety's sake (see also b, without this interpolated accord). 333. la: te '3 i iizs: is: The Augmented Sixth accord can also appear with the msijov fourth added, and is then called CHOED OF THE THIRD, FOURTH AND AUGMENTED SIXTH.' This accord may also enter free or not, at will, e. g. 333. W= S> — ia^ 'jz: -i9-,i 6 — 4 — 3 — Instead of the fourth, the major fifth may be added to the Augmented- Sixth accord, the combination being then named CHOED OF THE FIFTH AND AUGMENTED SIXTH. Its entrance is free or not, at option, but the resolution exhibits parallel ^ths*{see a, c and e, Ex. 334), unless the fifth of the accord is resolved pre- vious to the other voices, as at h and (i, or, unless it and the third are suspended until after the other voices are resolved, (seey). h. I c. d. , e. f. . — ~ I : -L^-l 3.34=. :2^^ iiy-r- f^ (2/ It L)^(k _ ' — -_J ■^ ^K -^ \ Further, the Tonic and Dominant may be unitedly sustained, while the up- per voices move independently of them, but, as before, according- to the rules presented. The dissonances over two tones will naturally be sharper than over one, e. g. Obgan-point upon the Tonio and Dominant. 33y. I iE -«(- 3^: -j_^i^--d---i :r<2:: G« = iie: :s?:i -J21 "JSL. is: '-HZL Harshest of all is an organ-point with three sustained tones. This very rarely occurs, but is not impossible. We find a very similar example to the following in Beethoven's Ninth Symphony. 33S. Finally, sustained-tones may appear in any of the upper voices. The sarao rules are to be observed as already given, e. g. Sustained tone in the Soprano. 830. Sustained tone in the Alto. 34:0. ( -J I L 32:r: O- i:=ri=j=:ir: CIZ2Z:: m i (m^^m J± ^ MANUAL OV MUSICAL THEOBT. 181 34=1. £eE^ Sustained tone in the Tenor. -9—*Z — tS/- 7zr ''^^-B^ :i. :^ — <5'- CHAPTER XXII. CONCERNING THE HARMONIC ACCOMPANIMENT OF A GIVEN MELODY. A melody or cantus firmiia having beea composed or selected, the follow- ing observatious and examples will practically indicate the manner of adding correct and acceptable harmonies thereto. I. Every tone of a given cantus firmus can he regarded as the octave, the third, or the fifth of a triad. II. The chosen triad may appear in its Fundamental or Third-Sixth po- sition. Kemaek. — The Fourth-Sixth position, which is, as we have several times remarked, the weakest, least independent of the three, is either to be avoided or used as it has been hitherto, or as will be presently explained. Every tone of a cantus firmus can belong to three different triads in ths same mode, e. g. 34.3. < I \J ^" n /m I---/-- ^ r'J ^J '^ ^ m m a V jy ^ m S 1 •^ ->9- ^- ^^ 1 '-^ -^ C A F In the first measure (Ex. 342) the C of the cantus firmus (c.f.j appears as octave of the C major triad; in the second measure, this same letter shows itself as third in the triad of A minor, and in the third measure, as fifth in the triad of F major. (The figures refer to the interval occupied by the c./.,and the letters underneath to the fundamentals). Every tone of a cantus firmus can also belong to three dififerent triads ia the similar-named mode (in the present case, C minor,) e. g. 8 3 5 34.3. Ab 132 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. From these two examples, we see that a single tone may belong to three dif- ferent triads in its own mode, and, when we digress from any certain major or minor mode to its similar-named minor or major mode, this same tone may be- long to three additional triads, a total of six. To enumerate in concise form, a single tone may appear as follows: — I. As octave of a major or minor triad. II. As major or minor third of a major or minor triad respectively. III. As ffth of a major or minor triad. Having shown what can be done with one tone, the next step will be to in- dicate how two different successive tones in a c.f. can be harmonically treated. To illustrate this, we will make use of the tones C and D (major second), and our endeavor in the following examples will be to learn what triads and what positions of those triads can appear upon such a canius j^r»iu.s; whether or not the two chords can succeed each other in their Fundamental positions, (i ;5), or the first one in its Fundamental (^) and the second iu its Third-Sixth position (t), or vice versa (3 3), or both in their Third-Sixth positions (§ 3). The following table presents a more condensed view of these various succes- sions: — |55j56l65|66l 33|33|83|33| I. If we apply such harmonies as will cause the C and D to appear as oc- taves of the fundamental of a triad, the triads will be C major and D minor, these two being common to the same mode, and according to the first formula (t ^),they will appear in their Fundamental positions, thus: — 344. In this formula, the Bass must also be C and D, tlierefore open octaves re- Bolt, and this harmonic accompaniment must be rejected. The second formula {^ t) will be found acceptable, the Bass acquiring thereby the tones, C and F, c. g. 345. <^ 2i MANUAL OF MUSICAL TIILOBY. 133 It will be proper to suggest that wherever possible, it is better if at least one voice progress in contrary motion to the others, (see the above example). This often prevents, or better conceals, objectionable voice-leadings. The third formula (f §) is also correct here, e. g. 34.6. ^==3^: 9- G D The fourth formula (f t) requires two Third-Sixth accords to follow each other. In cases where three out of four voices move in parallel motion, it will be found much easier if those three voices are written down first and the fourth voice added afterward, thus: — 34=7". The fourth voice may now be added, remembering that wherever it is placed U must progress in contrary motion to the remaining voices, e. g. 348. I 6 lis: C D C D This completes the simple triad-successions in which C and D are taken aa octaves of the fundamental. II. We will now apply such a harmonic accorapaniuient to these same letters as c.f. as will cause the C to appear as octave and D as third; the triads will therefore be C major and B diminished. Succeeding each other in their Funda- mental position (I 3), these triads require a special treatment. As B is the leading-tone in the mode of C major, the succession at a, Ex. 349, would not be acceptable, as it is always objectionable to double that tone when its char- acter as leading-tone shows itself so strongly as it does in the diminished triad (see remarks on this point, pages 92-3). Again, if the Tencr and Alto are led downward (as at b) in order to avoid doubling the lea-ding-tone, consecutive fifths arise which sound badly in tliis case notwithstanding the fact that the second is a minor fifth, a succes.sion sometimes quite allowable (see page 75). 134 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. By doubliug the third of the first accord (C major), thereby leaving out the fifth, aud leading this doubled tone in contrary motion, all these faults are avoided, (see Ex. 349 at c). not good. not good. good. 34.9. The second manner of succession (t §) cannot be used, on account of con- secutive octaves, thus: — m 350. P ^m We pass on to the third form (§ i)- This gives us again the Fundamental position of the diminished triad, which is always raw in its sound and more or less awkward to manipulate. However, by doubling the third of the first triad, and leading that duplication in contrary motion, the succession will be tolerable, thus: — '^ ^d= 351. ( 12?: ^ 125^?^' i C The last form {% %) will be found quite acceptable, as the Third-Sixth posi- tion of the diminished triad is its best, e. g. 353. W^ 12?: III. The accompaniment to this c. f. may be further varied by considering as octave and D as fifth, therefore the harmonies will be C major and G major. . In the first formula {\\) we give two examples, both of which are MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 10 ff 00 correct, the covered fifths, at h, not being objectionable ; the Bass, however, should fall, inasmuch as the other voices (at h) rise. !53. ) h 75^ 5 5 :^ C G The second form {%%) is also good, e. g. 354.. < g C G Of the different manipulations of the third form {%l) the following will be found the best: — 355. ( 6 5 C G The fourth form (§ i) is also good, e. g. 356. G G We have thus far regarded C as a member of the C major triad, viz : its octave, and have varied the succession by taking D as octave in the triad of D minor, then as third in the diminished triad of B, and finally as fifth in the triad of G major. IV. We will now consider C as a member of the A minor triad (third) and D,as before, first as octave, then third and finally Jifth in the triads of D mi- nor, B diminished and G major, respectively. Example 35*1, presents our c.f. (C D) harmonically accompanied by the triads of A and I) minor, in the different positions of these triads according 136 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. to the formula given on page 132. of the parallel octaves. The thh'd form must be rejected on account 357. y. Accompanying our cantus firniuH with the harmonies of A minor and B diminished, the third form (^ ^ needs special attention to the voice-leading in order to avoid an objectionable covered fifth (see Ex. 358 at c) or doubling the leading tone. Its correct treatment is seen at d. The fourth form (^ ^) is to be rejected on account of unavoidable parallel octaves (see e). 358. 1 had. better, pj -yp iiEi^g^= :^ {m _-^^^ 6 5 6 VI. In example 359, C appears as third in the triad of A minor, and D as ■fifth in that of G major. Each of the four formula) are usable in this suc- cession: — 359. VII. In the following examples, C is taken as fifth in the triad of F major, and D, first as octave, then third, and then as fifth in the triads of D minor, B diminished, and G major, respectively. The four forms of succession may all be used with the triads of F major and D minor, e. g. ^ — ^ — ^ — '-^ — ■ — \—.^ 300. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 137 YIII. Our c.f. accompanied by the triads of F major and B diminished, requires special attention in the first and third formula, where the diminished triad appears in its Fundamental position (see remarks in connection with Ex. 358), e.g. I ■ 4 L_J ! L 361. IX. Using the triads of F and G major upon our e. /., the first formula must be rejected on account of the unavoidable parallel fifths. The third form is only tolerable, on account of the distance between the voices, necessitated by the difficulty of avoiding faulty voice-leading, e. g. 363. The variety of harmonic accompaniment upon this same c.f. (C D) may be greatly increased by applying the following harmonies, according to the various formula? heretofore used, as C and D are component tones of these triads also. The chord-successions will therefore be as follows: — KV- Major to T) Diminished. " ' " Bl2 Major. " " G Major or Minor. C Minor to D Diminished. " " " Bb Major. " " " G Major or Minor. F Minor to D Diminished. " " Bb Major. " " G Major or Minor. With the assistance of the precediog examples and explanations, it will not be a difficult matter to work out the additional successions above enumerated. Where unavoidable faulty voice-leadings show themselves, the succession is of course to be rejected. It will be found, when the above chord-successions have been as fully developed as those already worked out, that this simple can- tus Jirmus of two tones can be harmonically accompanied in nearly fifty dif- ferent ways with triads alone, and the voice-leading, even in the simple form we have here used, may be almost infinitely varied. All the remaining intervals presented in a major scale should now be treated the same as the foregoing major second (C D). We present below, example 138 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 363, the principal intervals which are most likely to appear in a well-con- structed melody, and if each of these intervals are taken seperately as a c.f. and its possible harmonic accompaniment worked out according to examples 344 to 3G2, the pupil will have acquired the ability to harmonize (with triads) any moderately difficult melody, for each two tones in such a melody will very probably be identical with some one of the intervals here practiced. The let- ters in the following table indicate to what harmonies the note underneath may belong. The triad-succession in the exercises to be worked out, ^s that from each of the three fundamentals over the first note to each of the three fun- damentals over the second note, in each interval. For example using C B as the cantus frmus, the major triad of C may progress to the diminished triad of B, or to the major triad of G, or to the minor triad of E. The minor triad of A (0 is its third) may then progress to the same, and finally the ma- jor triad of F, (C is its ffth) may make the same progressions also. In each of the progressions, the same formulae are to be employed as heretofore, viz : 5515616 5 1661 and such as cannot be accomplished without faulty voice- 33|33|33|33|' ^ •' leadings are to be rejected. Fa C b» bo C. 363. D F B= F C F c F BO F F A DAE A E A D A A C F C G C G C F C F A C A C E G F ■t5>- G. The major fourth and major seventh are not regarded as melodic intervals, and should never be made use of except where a sequence in the melody com- pels it, as for example: — 364.. i -xf- -t9- 1 •^ N.B. The harmonic accompaniment to a major scale may now be attempted in the following sinij)Ie manner. First write down tlie scale by itself, and place over each note the fundamental of the triad which may be chosen to accom- pany that note. These triads are to be chosen with due regard to clearly in- dicating the key at the beginning and at the end, and the securing of a flow- ing connection of harmonies between these two points, e. g. 365. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 139 We commence here with the Tonic, Dominant and Tonic-triads (authentic close), which fixes the key as C major. / The next tone (F) being the Sub- dominant, the Sub-dominant-triad (F, A, C), will very naturally accompany it. Upon the next tone (G) we might use the triad of G major, ])ut in that case there would be no connecting tone with the preceding triad of F major. The triad of E minor, to which G belongs, would also have no connecting tone. 'V\\Q triad of C major again, best answers our purpose. The following tone being A, and the close of the passage approaching, the Sub-dominant-triad may be used to good advantage as part of the cadence. If the next tone (B) be reckoned as third in the triad of G major, we should again have two triads Avithout a connecting tone (F major and G major), and the triad of E minor (B is its fifth) together with C major would not form a satisfactory close (see remarks on this point, page 82). It will be found most acceptable to use the diminished triad of B, which furnishes one connecting tone with the triad of F major, (see above, Ex. 365.) Remark. — The above cadence, though often used in former times at the close of a composition, does not possess falling inflection enough to be satisfactory at that place, in the present day. It is used now as a partial cadence only, indicative of the close of a phrase or section. It is used in that sense here, as will be seen by referring to the fully harmonized scale, example 371, page 141. Having chosen the harmonies to be used, the next point will be to add the Bass. It is especially iuiportaut that this voice, as well as the Soprano, shall be as melodic as possible, as these two voices are heard most prominently. For this reason it is not always best that th^ fundamental of the accord be the Bass, but rather the third sometimes, and occasionally the ffth. The follow- ing Bass to our scale would be correct but not melodic: — C G C F G. 366. §ieE^EEi ■X "We can begin, if we choose, with a Third-sixth accord ; this may be followed by the Fourth-Sixth position of the G major triad, and this by the Fundamental position of the C major triad. This secures a melodic Bass. Again, in the third measure, the Bass is more flowing if the C major triad occurs in its Third-Sixth position, instead of the Fundamental. In the last measure, the diminished triad must appear in its Tliird-Sixth position, e. g. 307, 140 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. The two principal voices having been written down, (this is decidedly the most practical way) the inner voices are next in order. It makes no material diflfereuee which is first attended to, as each is equally important, it only being necessary to write the first high or low enough to leave space for the other. Every effort should be made to secure as natural a flow for all the voices as possible, and when similar motion appears in the outer voices, cause at least one of tlie inner voices to remain stationary, or, better still, to progress in con- trary motion. As we have already said, it is not altogether acceptable when all the voices rise or fall at the same time. We present the completed exer- cise in No. 368, calling attention to the melodic flow of the Bass, and the close connection of the harmonies. 368. PASSING CHORD. We have purposely introduced the Fourth-Sixth accord here (see fii'st meas- ure, Ex. 368) in order to show another way in which this chord may be used. We have hitherto used it as a retardation before another triad in its Funda- mental position upon the same Bass, (see Complete Cadences, page 100). It had there almost the character of a dissonance and was treated with a, so to speak, resolution. It occurred there invariably upon an accented measural- division. In the above example, this chord appears as a Passing Chord. It occurs unaccented, as will always be the case in its character of passing chord, and the Bass must always be treated exactly like a passing-note; i. e., it must be gained and left degree-wise. The other voices are to be treated as in any chord-connection. In a similar manner we will now attempt to harmonize the descending major scale of C. Of the many ways in which tliis may be accomplished, we choose a sequence form, in which the Soprano of the first accord is the octave, and that of the second accord the thir-d, and repeat this as many times as is prac- ticable. The close must be effected with a satisfactory cadence, the authen tic, tor instance, e. g. OGa e FCGC 300. 32: ::y -i2z:±rz. +'^— ^-'g- We call attention again to the motion of the voices. Inasmuch as the outer voices are heard most prominently, it is better, if practicable, that they move in contrary or oblique motion. With little exception this has been done in the above example. Wherever similar motion appears in the outer voices, the 146 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. inner voices should be so led as to counteract this. One or both of them may be led in contrary motion to the other voices (see 5th measure, Ex. 386), or, one or both may sustain then- tones, thus creating oblique motion to the others (see N.B., Ex. 386). If the c.f. progresses spring-wise, it is advisable to cause the Bass to move by degrees. 3. The inner voices are finally to be added, and as melodically as the nature of the case will allow, e. g. 3S6. In harmonizing a given determined c.f., we are not always obliged to retain connecting tones in the same voices, as we are allowed greater freedom in the voice-leading than in simple chord-successions, because the melody is the chief consideration here, while in the other case (chord-successions) the harmony or progression of all the voices as a whole, claimed the most attention. We can therefore omit the ffth in a Third-Fifth accord and double the Bass or the third in its stead ; or, in a Third-Sixth accord, we can omit the thij'd and double the Bass or sixth instead, whenever a better voice-leading can thereby be secured. Not more than one octave should intervene, as a general rule, be- tween the Soprano and Alto, or Alto and Tenor. This remark does not apply to the Bass and Tenor. The above c.f. or others should now be used in the pupil's individual efforts in this direction. In lieu of an original c.y.,the mel- ody of any one of the many well-known chorals will answer the purpose. CHAPTER XXIII. BOUND DISSONANCES. BOUND SUSPENSIONS. LIGATURE OR TIE, SYNCOPE. • If the accord of C major, in the following example, progresses to that of G major, the most natural voice-leading will be as presented here; i. e., the G will be retained as upper voice; the middle voice (E) will fall a degree to D; and the Bass (C) will likewise fall a degree to B, e. g. 887*. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 147 Remark. -The fourth voice is inieutionally omitted but will be added in later examples. lu Example 388 we present the same chord-succession with a change in the treatment of one voice: — 38S. The upper voice in the above example remains and the Bass falls a degree, as before, but the progression of the middle voice is suspended, inasmuch aa it lingers for a time upon its tone in the first accord, and after the other voicea have assumed their places in the new accord, it (the middle voice) moves to its proper place a Iso (to D). The D is hereby retarded or delayed and the E forms what is called a Suspension before that tone (D). The first combination of tones, produced by the suspension of the E (B, E, (x), presents as intervals a fourth and sixth; the figuring of the chord will therefore be |. The fourth forms a suspension before the third in the following chord, while the sixth remains. The above is not properly a dissonant suspension, but is nevertheless usable in the strictest style. In connection with the same chord-succession as that in Example 381, we present another treatment of one of its voices, in Example 389. 3 SO. n -^j- 1 aL fe «--= ^ ^^ 5 6 2 3 \r\' 1 T' V o '^'^ ^ In this example, the upper two voices are treated as in Example 387, while the progression of the Bass (C) is suspended until after the other voices have assumed their places in the new accord, when it then moves to its destined place also (to B). Here arises a dissonance, at the beginning of the second measure, viz: between the Bass and middle voice (C and D). The resolution of the dissonant tone (C) takes place when the Bass falls to B, where the Third- Sixth accord first appears. The D stands as a second to the Bass (C) of the dissonant accord, and the G as fifth ; the figuring is therefore ^ and the chord of resolution ^. In ichafever chord-succession hound dissonant suspensions are to be em- ployed, the following rules are to be strictly observed. There are three lead- ing points to be fastened in the mind," viz: I. Preparation. II. Atlark. III. Resolution. 148 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. I. PREPARATION. That note which forms the diswiiance or suspension, must have been con- sonant in the preceding accord. The consonance part of this bound note is termed the preparation, and the dissonance part is the suspension itself. For example, in No. 390, the note C is a consonant in the first accord, therefore, the note of preparatioji; it is then bound or suspended, and, through a progres- sion of the other voices, becomes dissonant. In connection with the prepara- tion of a suspension, it is to be remembered that the preparation-note (the consonance) may be longer than the note of suspension (the dissonance) as seen at a, Example 390, or, the preparatioyi and suspension may be of equal length (see b, Ex. 390), but the preparation-note viust never be shorter than the note of suspension (see Ex. 390 at c). This is done in order to oppose a counter-balance to the dissonance. The entrance of the preparation-note may take place accented or unaccented: — 0'- 0. C. incorrect. 300. _Q -Jh :^ _ -^-^ __ ___. =: ! ^ (S- G>- ^- £/- 6> ^ 5 6 2 3 1 ,5i -4— or- 5 C 2 3 L ^ * ,27— 1 \ —4 5-- >s S=5^- " a —QL ^ — ■■ - r <» cy ^ =J R,6q Ri&a" ft<(<^ This rule for the Ligature or Tie is to be regarded throughout the entire science of music. The first note of a Tie must never be shorter than the second, it makes no difference whether the second note becomes dissonant or not. When an instance occurs, contrary to this rule, it is done either through caprice (see opening measures of Beethoven's Sonata in G major. Op. 31, No. 1) or througli negligence. The reason for the prohibition is to be found in the limping, halting effect produced when the rule is disregarded. II. ATTACK. The attach of the dissonance or entrance of the suspension, (the poiat where, by the progression of the other voices, the consonant pre))aration-note tarns to be dissonant) must always take place upon an accented part of the measure, (see the following example at a and b) and never unaccented, as at c. Ct. o. c. incorrect. 301. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 149 III. RESOLUTION. This takes place when the bouud dissonance falls* one diatonic degree (whole or half-step). Thus, the resolution in Example 391 takes place when the C (the bound dissonance) falls a half-step to B. The entrance of the note of resolution may be accented or unaccented at will. In regard to the 7'esohdion of a dissonant suspen-uon, we desire to say that as a dissonance is but the melodic retardation of a consonance, it is just as logically correct for that dissonance to resolve upward to a consonance as downward. The musical instinct awaits the resolution to a consonance. The direction in which that consonance is approached is of secondary importance. That the dissonance, like nearly everything else, more willingly falls than rises is granted. It was this observation which caused former theorists to allow only the degree-wise descending resolution, but that the ascending resolution is equally correct is proven by the just-mentioned principle. To illustrate, take for example the suspension of the second. In this suspension, the upper tone cannot fall nor the lower tone rise to the unison, because a dissonance cannnt appear as the retardation of a tone already pre. J The first three of the following examples show that passing notes may inter- vene between the bound dissonance and its resolution. At d, Example 399, the bound dissonance (C) springs to a note (A) which is not an accord-tone of the G major triad (the chord of resolution). The tone A is here used as an appoggiatura to B (see page 77 on this point). 309. I m zsz. ^^^^JzfMz, ~sr ---^J>: P5 rizL In the following examples, we wish to point out and correct a very prevalent fault, another violation of the rule set forth on page 150. The upper voices in Example 400, present one of the foregoing suspensions, while the Bass moves in a form of accompaniment or arpeggio. The fault is this, that the Bass makes use of the retarded tone, B (see x), previous to the resolution of the Bospension to that tone (see rule, page 150). 400. >^— u>^- 152 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. The fault may be easily obviated by so leading the Bass as to avoid that tone (B), at least until the resolution of the suspended tone takes place (as at a or 6, Ex. 40r h. 401. Here will follow suspensions upon other chord-successions, observing the same rule throughout. In the succession of the triads of C major and D minor (see a, Example 402), the Soprano may be suspended, as at h, or the Alto, as at c, or both Soprano and Alto, as at d. No suspension of the Tenor or Bass is practicable here, because the first-named springs (C — A) and the last would be obliged to resolve upward to a tone already present (D, in the Alto), a. h. c. d. ■403. SUSPENSION OF THE NINTH. At c, Example -402, the rule given on page 150 appears to be disregarded, inasmuch as the note of resolution (D) appears in the Bass previous to the res- olution of the suspension to that t(me. This is one of the exceptions alluded to in connection with that rule; it is the jBass alone which has the inherent power or weight to sustain such a progression. The above suspension (at c) is that of the ninth before the octave; it is therefore denominated Suspension of the Ninth; its figuring is ^ f,or 9 8. That no other voice is capable, like the Bass, of sustaining a suspension before its own tone, eithel* above or below, will be seen by comparison of the examples iu No. 403: — Correct Incorrect 403. |i5E|^i|E|E|;|[ Suspensions from above Sunpensioiu from belmo Kemark. — To fxjilain away any misunderstanding in connection with the faulty Bass in Example dOO, lest some may think that that is an instance of the suspension of the ninth, we would s;iy that the broken-accord there represents the triad of G ma- jor, thcruforc B, bciup; the third of the Bass (G), is really a middle voice. (See subject of broken-accords, page 76). MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBY. 153 The suspension at a, Example 404, has been used by our best authorities oa Counterpoint, but is to be understood and figured as a suspension of the ninth ("see 6), although the exact interval is a second, e. g. b. 4=04=. m ^ (Z- --^3-- Tan 1 .8 The following succession of the triads of D minor and C major is of course entirely forbidden on account of the parallel fifths (see a, Ex. 405). The fault is the same with the introduction of suspensions (see b), therefore the following italicized principle: A suspension does not remove or palliate the eff^ect of a faulty progression. a. parallel fifths : b. no better:^ 4=0 o. Upon the chord -succession at a, Example 406, we present suspensions upon each descending voice, first singly, as at h, c and d, then with two voices, as at e,/and g, and, finally, with three voices (at h), a triple suspension, with an added cadence. a. b. c. d. e. 4=06 We have given, in the above example, all the suspensions possible to the chord-succession in question, in order to indicate what may be attempted by the pupil with other chord-successions, although not many will admit of so 154 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. manifold a development as this. Of the above suspensions, the one at e will always be the least acceptable, on account of the succession of fourths (see =). This is always crude where there are no other progressing voices, as here. The very same fourths, however, are seen in the second measure at h, but a pro- gressing third voice (Tenor) entirely obviates the unpleasant effect alluded to. Suspensions may also be effectively employed in Cadences. I. We present at a, Example 407, the Plagal Cadence to C major, and at b, c and d, examples of applied suspensions to this and the same cadence in A minor and F major, with different placing of the upper voices. ^&. . c. [— ~! , d. Aoy. The example at h could not end in the following manner, because, in the time here used {alia breve ^),the close would take place unaccented, e. g. 4=08. S^l^S^ §a^ :a: For this reason the resolution of the suspension is delayed at h, Example 401, (by an appoggiatura) until the beginning of the following measure, where an accent is secured for the final chord. The example at c, No. 40 1, is also very similar. The example at d needs no explanation more than that the note of resolution (A) is embellished by one of its auxiliary tones (G). II. To the Authentic Cadence: — 4=OG. f^. ^:=te= ^iii' ■^-- Supensions may be applied as in Ex. 410: — a. .'"'.. , h. 4:10. ^?BE|: ^ «<-. — ^ -^- :-^- t aip: \ 'it -«--•—?• I /_1___^_^_ MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY, d. 'J2L LTiStll -6>G>- §^^ % -T— ?^ Tiz: i^: r- 155 It is not obligatory that the suspension be bound. The simple delay in the progression of any voice, according to our given rules, produces a suspension, whether the tone be bound or not. The suspensions are indicated in the above examples by dotted lines. The progression of fourths, as for example: — 411. :b: is improved by causing the F to move to E? after the B!? goes to A, as seen in the Alto and Tenor at c, Example 410. III. In the Complete Cadence: — 413. [5:^2: -^z , 1 — -r!- 6 — 5 4 S te^^ O- zsu -t!? 157 Jrt JAc (Sop. <€ Tenor. bin '6 '2. etc. 3 - :sr ^EB^ ;i 1©^ \i/ If the fifth of the Tonic-triad be given to the upper voice, another equally favorable entrance of the Third-Sixth accord upon the Sub-dominant is gained, as the Soprano and Alto fall degree-wise, admitting the application of single or double suspensions, e. g In the Soprano. 418. < In the Alto. In the Soprano and Alto. ^^ -^-^ JI21 :2=-.^;= iJ \ r .3ip£ To the following formula of the Complete Cadence: 4HO. ,k^; 9 5S?e 321 iSae -l5»- -6>- r7s L_^ J. suspensions can be readilv applied, as in Example 420: — 4.30. 3p:Z=5 — '[ d: 4 3 ^^ 1 3?:: 158 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. That formula, in wliich the Doiniimnt-triad iinracdiately precedes that of the Sub-dominant, does no*, allow of classical suspensions between those two chords, because none of the upper voices fall. 4.21. It will be found a most valuable practice here to repeat all or a part of the exercises in modulation given .on pages 102 to 122, applying suspensions to such voices as fall degree-wise, in the raanuer that we have so copiously illus- trated in the foregoing pages. We give below, a few examples of such mod- ulations; for example, first from F major to A major, an elevation of four relative degrees, e. g. F— A. 4.33. Second, from a major to a minor; for example, E major to F minor, a de- ^■ipression of eight relative degrees. It v,'ill be proper to remark here that in ■ modulations by elevation, suspensions can be more frequently applied than in modulations by depression, on account of the greater frequency of degree-wise falling voices, e. g. E— F 483. iie _j^ _"", N.B. lis bf, 'I --5^. _J2_ 1 Suspensions could be employed at N. B., Example 423, there being two voices which progress degree-wise downward. They were omitted in order to ■better preserve the symmetry of the rhythm (compare the sections). A double suspension is introduced in the cadence. Third, from a minor to a major; for example, from D minor to B major, an elevation of six relative degrees, e. g. MANUAL OF MViHCAL THEORY. 159 N.B. 4 34.. i^ii^pliil^pp^l t - tJ6 \ — -¥- i The cadence, in the Last example, is extended by means of an organ-point, thereby secnring a better rounded musical })eriod than if the close took place at N. B. An example of modulations from minor to minor, \vith suspensions, might be given, but will scarcely l)e necessary after the foregoing; the pupil will only need the suggestion in order to accomplish it alone. At this point we leave the subject of Suspensions, to be taken up again at the proper time and revieAved in connection with other accords, including their use in the mod- ern or romantic style of composition. CHAPTER XXIV. CHORDS OF THE SEVENTH. If two triads which are related in the third, for example C major and E minor (see a, Ex. 425), are united in one combination of tones (6), a disso- nant accord arises: — 43 The intervals contained in this dissonant accord (6) are a tMrd, fifth and seventh; consequently, the figuring in full will be I j the following are also used:^ or | or ?. Such combinations are called Chords of the Seventh, or, more briefly. Seventh accords. A Chord of the Seventh results from the union of any two triads which are related in the third, as for example C major and A minor (Ex. 426, a and h). 4=36. ^: — g — g- fEtl m Further, a Chord of the Seventh can be formed upon every degree of the major or minor scale, thus: — 4:3'*' "-ir \ -^r' ■ — \ -r^r' 1 — \ "i^ 1 — ^-(5'- Xsi degree IQQ MANUAL OF *MUSICAL TEEOBT. In the Normal scale of A miDor, the Chords of the Seventh are precisely the same as those given in Example 427, beginning with the 6th (A). In the bolder minor mode (see page 44) there are four additional seventh accords, situated upon the first, third, fifth and seventh degrees, as follows: — 1st. Znd. 3rd. ith. 5th. 6th. 1th. Again, in the milder major mode, that in which the Snb-dominant-triad is minor, (in C major, F, Ab, C) we have another tone (Ai?) which we may intro- duce into four of the Seventh accords in the mode of C major, viz: those upon the second, fourth, sixth and seventh degrees, thus: — 4.29.^-' In some of these Seventh accords the dissonance is so harsh as to always require that the chord be prepared; i.e., the seventh must appear as a sw&se- quent-seventh or as a bound dissonance. Others, again, are of so mild a na- ture that they may enter y>*ee; i. e., unprepared. These are such as contain a diminished triad. Of the above, those marked with an asterisk (x) contain a diminished triad, and are thereby allowed this privilege. For our next exercises, we will make use of that Seventh accord located on the Dominant. It consists of the union of a major and diminished triad, its intervals being a major third, major fifth and minor seventh. This particular combination is denominated CHORD OP THE DOMINANT SEVENTH. This accord is formed in the same manner in both major and minor modes, since the Dominant-triad in minor modes is generally major. In the mode of A minor, for example, the Chord of the Dominant Seventli consists of the union of the major triad of E and the diminished triad of Gjif (see a and h, Ex. 430). a. jo, b. jsl\ A30. ^- ^ ^ I =VJJa The Dominant Seventh accord in the mode of C minor consists of the union of the major triad G, Btj, D, and the diminished triad Btj, D, F, (Ex. 431, a). This is exactly the same as the Dominant Seventh accord in the mode of C major (6). We learn from this that this accord is precisely the same in simi- lar-named modes, e. g. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 161 Ijikc all chords, Chords of the Seventh cau be used in different positions. If all the tones stand third-wise one above the other, or are brought into that relation, it is the FUNDAMENTAL POSITION. The lowest tone is then the fundamental of the chord. This same tone re- mains the fundamental in whatever position the chord may appear, the same as in triiids. Example 432 exhibits the close and one open Fundamental posi- tion of the Dominant Seventh accord in C major, the whole notes indicating the fundamental, and the figures, the mode of abbreviating the chord. 43 ^m 1^1 When the original third (the third of the fundamental) appears as the Bass or lowest tone, there arises the FIFTH-SIXTH POSITION OF THE CHORD OF THE SEVENTH. It is also called Chord of the FifOi and Sixth, or, still more briefly, Fifth- Sixth accord. The intervals therein contained are a third, fifth and sixth, e. g. 4=3 3.§i: S==i^-==i When the original fifth appears as the Bass, there arises the THIED-FOURTH POSITION OF THE CHORD OF THE SE\TENTH. (CHOKD OF THE THIRD AND FOUBTH, Or THIED-FOUKTH ACCOED. ) Its intervals are a third, fourth and nixth, e. g. 6 4 4 . 3 3 434. ^^=:g— -<&- When the original seventh appears as the Bass, there arises the POSITION OF THE SECOND OF THE CHORD OF THE SEVENTH. (CHOKD OF THE SECOND, Or SECOND ACCOED. ) Its intervals are a second, fourth and sixth, e. g. • ^ 4 2 4 2 6 2 2 C\' 1 -13 5 )' J^ZI • • ^ * • L_, J * This and many future examples, where we have used only one staff, will sound better if sung or played an octave bijilier. For the sake of greater ease in reading the examples, we Xv.xxc- <»u. deavored, when nothing was thereby sacriflced, to avoid too freiiueut use of Icger lines and spaces 162 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TREOBY. As in the character of every dissonaut accord, so also iu Chords of the Seventh there is an inherent striving toward a point of rest; i. e., toward a consonant triad. The progression of the chords under present consideration to such a point of rest is termed, KESOLUTION OF THE CHOKD OF THE SEVENTH. Every Seventh accord has several different resolutions (progressions to dif- ferent triads), the primary or principal being that in which the fundamental falls a major ffth, while the other voices (the original third, ^/A and .seventh) progrees to the tones forming a consonant ti'iad upon this new tone. RESOLUTION OF THE DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD. The chief resolution of this particular Chord of the Seventh is to the Tonic- triad of that major or minor key to which its fundamental., as Dominant, be- longs. The primary or chief resolution of the Dominant Seventh accord G, B, D, F, is to the Tonic-triad of C major (C, E, G) or C minor- (C, Ei?, G). The lead- ing of each voice to the triad of C major, for example, will be as follows: — 1. THE FUNDAIMENTAL. We have always connected chord-successions by retaining similar tones in the same voices. The same may be done here, as G, i\\Q fundamental of this Dominant Seventh accord, is common also to the triad of C major, thus: — 4=36 ^ 2. THE SEVENTH OE DISSONANCE. After the fundamental, the seventh is the next voice to be attended to. A dissonance always anticipates or creates the expectancy of a consonance. This expectancy is satisfied Avlien the dissonance resolves to the consonance. In order to secure the highest effect for this resolution, the consonance or note of resolution, must be a tone not found in any voice of the chord to which the dissonance belonged, or, iu other words, a tone which has been heard with (he dissonance cannot be effectively used immediately afterwards as tlie resolution of that dissonance. Tlie anticipative character of tiie dissonance would be destroyed were this natural law disregarded. It will be seen here, therefore, that the seventh (F, the dissonance in the Seventh accord) cannot be resolved upward to G in the C major triad, as that tone (G) has been heard with the dissonance, just mentioned, (see dotted line in Ex. 437). 4.3r. ^ — ^ — i^ — MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. ]^g3 Beiug obliged to reject this resolution of the seventh, we next try its down- ward progression to another tone in the chord of resolution, viz: to E, as in Example 438: — ? — 1- a 1- 4.38. r^zn The tone E, not having been heard with the dissonance, and being a mem- ber of the triad of resolution (C, E, G), can therefore serve acceptably as the resolution to that dissonance. We are now enabled to establish the following rule: — In the primary or principal resolution of each and every chord of the seventh, the original seventh, in whatever p)osition the chord may he placed, resolves a diatonic degree downward (whole or half-step). 3. THE THIRD. The third in a Dominant Seventh accord is always the leading-tone in that mode. Its best progression is to the Tonic as usual, therefore in this case, B will progress to C, e. g. 439. __ 4. THE FIFTH. The last tone, (D) the ffth, could if necessary move upward to E. That would double the third of the chord of resolution, as the seventh (F) also re- solves to E. It is better, as we have already remarked, to double the Tonic, that tone being the foundation of the chord. Consequently, we resolve the fifth (D) downward to the Tonic (C), e. g. 440. ^' fr y: §^ 4 The resolution of the Seventh accord here is to a "Fourth-SLxth accord, which is not so satisfactory as might be wished, on account of the dependence of that chord. To secure a firmer foundation for the chord of resolution, the Bass (G) of the Seventh accord, not being dissonant or requiring any determined progression, can move freely to the fundamental (C) of that chord of resolu- tion, as in Ex. 441: — 4.41, 131^=^ In the last example, the fundamental (C) of the chord of resolution ap- pears three times, the third once, while the ffth is omitted. When the lead- ing-tone appears as 'a middle voice, it is privileged to make an irregular pro- gression downward to the ffth of the chord of resolution, in order to give that chord greater fullness, e. g. /^ — ^-/9 ' 4.43. 164 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. If the leading-tone lies in an outer voice, its progression, on account of its prominence, must talce place regularly to the Tonic (see Ex's. 443 and 444), except in rare cases where a sequence might condition a different leading. The resolution of the Seventh accord in its Fundamental position having been so amply explained, the resolution of its other positions will offer no especial difficulty since the same dh-ections are to be observed in the leading of each individual voice. RESOLUTION OF THE FIFTH-SIXTH ACCORD. 44=3. ii^^ ?:S- The fundamental (see Ex. 443) may be bound; the original seventh (F) cannot resolve upward to G, because that tone has already been heard with the dissonance, it must, therefore, fall to E; the Bass (B) or original third, being the leading-tone and occurring in an outer voice, must progress regularly to the Tonic; the D (original Jiflh) falls best to C, thereby doubling the funda- mental of the chord of resolution. RESOLUTION OF THE THIRD-FOURTH ACCORD. -y- ■■ 1 VL ^ '^ m-^^ — -— «-J A 3 rS- bl* jO zr &'- ^ 4. 4. A . Tlie fundamental (G, see Ex. 444) may be retained in the same voice; the original seventh (F) falls to E; the original third (B, the leading-tone in au outer voice) rises to the Tonic, and the original ffth (D) as Bass, falls best to the Tonic, as before. Cases often occur, however, in which the fifth in a Seventh accord is led upward, e. g. 4^!S. 9- z^;:^-^:^ MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. RESOLUTION OF THE CHORD OF THE SECOND 165 44,6. :E _^ p= zsn It is to be remarked that as the origiual seventh always appears as Bass of the Chord of the Second, its primary resolutiou is invariably to a Third-Sixth accord. OMISSION OF TONES IN CHORDS OF THE SEVENTH. The Jiflh cau be omitted with the least detriment to the chord, the funda- mental bm\^ usually doubled in its stead (see Ex. 447). The third cau be rarely omitted, and the fundamental or seventh never, for the chord would then become a simple triad. 4.^7. -y-' ■■ /fc= ,— ^ m — 1^^ -$; _ _ •J "^■r- O ^ — A \ - , 1 We see still more clearly, in Example 447, that the seventh (F) could not re- solve upward to Gr on account of that tone being already occupied. It must therefore M\ to E. If the fundamental of a Seventh accord is doubled in an upper voice, its progression to the chord of resolution is freest of all the voices, (see a, b, c, Ex. 448). 448.^ The fundamental as Bass, however, has not so manifold a privilege. For example, the following would not be acceptable on account of the too percep- tible octaves: — bad: 4=49. 2h 166 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. ■ CHAPTER XXV. CHORD OF THE DOMINANT SEVENTH CONTINUED. ITS ENTRANCE AND RESOLUTION AFTER THE TONiC-TRIAD OF THE SAME MODE. I. ENTRANCE OF THE FUNDAMENTAL POSITION. The Chord of the Dominant Seventh can always enter free; i. e., spring or degree-wise. Faulty progressions are of course to be avoided, and an endeav- or made to secure as melodic a leading for each voice as possible. In No. 450 we present examples of the entrance of this chord, in its Fun- damental position, after the Tonic-triad, the placing of the voices in the triad being that in whicli the octave is given to the Soprano. The resolution of the Seventh accord is also added. a. h. c. 4.50. ~y~ -, . .^ tf»-^ — - ^-j: 1 f(^ ^i''"** 15 ^Jz ^"^ -^ __^ X7^^ li'-"*" 7 -^ 7 7 ' — £^ — — c^- iTJ 1 /S? \ ^' — ^^ -^y — ^— — - — f'j - -^ 1 Attention should be directed to the motion of the voices; cause at least one voice to move in contrary motion, to the others, espeei;illy where there is no connect- ing tone (a and 6, Ex. 450). Ata, the_^/7/i inthe chordof resolution is omitted be- cause the B, as leading-tone in an outer voice, must rise to the Tonic, and the seoenth (F) necessarily falls to E. The same thing happens at b, although it is not so necessary for the leading-tone in tliat example to resolve to the Tonic, occurring as it does, in a middle voice. At c, the Jifth in the Seventh acconl is omitted, the fundamental being doubled instead, thereby making tlie cliord of resolution complete. In the following examples (451) the Soprano of the Tonic-triad has the third : — 3 h. butter. C. 4=51. The entrance of the Seventh accord at a, Example 451, is not very good, although sometimes used. That at b is better. At c, the leading-tone (Gijt) appearing as a middle voice, can fall to the fifth iu the chord of resolution for tlie sake of greater fullness. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 167 Example 452 shows the entrauce of a Dominant Seventh accord after the Tonic-triad with the fifth in the Soprano. a. 5 h. c. I I ... S ^^ ^- -o Although the entrauce at a is often used, those at h and c are to be regarded better. At c, the chord in parenthesis may be used, should a firmer close be desired. In the foregoing, as well as in the following examples, it will be found useful practice to place the voices of the Tonic-triad in open position and then effect the entrance of the Dominant Seventh accord. ENTRANCE OF THE FIFTH-SIXTH POSITION OF A DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD AFTER THE TONIC-TRIAD. 4.53. f» yr/5> (5? i : 6 5 6 m d. better. Though used, the examples at c and / are not entirely unobjectionable, for the reason that all the voices move in similar motion, in addition to the suc- cession of fifths, which latter are usually acceptable on account of the second one being a minor fifth, A better entrauce is seen at d, e and g. As the Bass of this position of the Dominant Seventh accord is always the leading-tone, it follows that that voice cannot be doubled, as in Example 45-4. If it were doubled, open octaves would necessarily result, for the leading-tone, as such, has only one progression, — that to the Tonic: — 4.54L. i i^ -^ 168 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. ENTRANCE OF THE THIRD-FOURTH POSITION OF THE DOMINANT- SEVENTH ACCORD AFTER THE TONIC-TRIAD. 455 ENTRANCE OF THE POSITION OF THE SECOND OF THE DOMINANT- SEVENTH ACCORD AFTER THE TONIC-TRIAD. 8 , . 3 ■156. _^ ^ ^_^ \ U-r_ -s«- lg:3: c ■t9- i ;] 3=r — ^ — r—g — b gg— h — g?— <^— b^ — V.—o—^—r^ \ ^ 6 ■^ 1^ APPLICATION OF SUSPENSIONS IN CONNECTION WITH THE DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD. A suspeusion applied to the eiilrance of the Domhiaat Seventh accord after a triad must observe all the rules already giveu (see page 147). I. 27ie note, of preparation mud be conaonanl and an long or longer than the diasonance. II The attack of the dissonance must be accented. III. The resolution of the dissonance must be degree-wise downward. In No. 457 we presgnt a few examples of suspensions applied to i\\Q entrance of the Fundamental position of the Dominant Seventh accord after the triad MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 169 of C major. Upon every voice which falls degree-wise ia this entrance, the ap- plication of suspensions may be effected, e. g. 45y. As the entrance of the vSeventh accord in Example 458, takes place with ascending voices, it follows that classical suspensions cannot be applied: — 4.58. -J51 450. -d=^I 7 — 5 — 4 $ 7 — 6 5 4 3 11 better: 460. At h, Example 460, the C does not become dissonant by being bound, there- fore no resolution is necessary. The Bb is only a subsequent-seventh, and the example can not be regarded as a suspension. We understand by s^uspension a tone which, by becoming dissonant, determines for itself a certain fixed pro. gi^eiidoii or resolution. On the contrary, a bound or retarded tone (as at h) which remains consonant, can spring to any other consonance or progress de- gree-wise in either direction. The example at c is rather objectionable on ac- count of the prominence of the progression of fifths. The example at d is better. 170 MA N^ UAL OF irUSICAL THEORY. A few examples of suspensions upon the entrance of the Dominant-Seventh accord in its other positions are seen in No. 461. Fifth-Sixth Accord : Third-Fourth Accord : Second Accord : -iOl. APPLICATION OF SUSPENSIONS IN THE EESOLUTION OF THE 4L03. SEVENTH ACCORD. &• N.B. I z^^^^S: N.B. is: s^ 32:: f^ In the above examples (b and c) the suspensions at N.B., violate the rule which says that the note of preparation must be consonant, as it will be seen here that tlie seventh (the disi^onance) is used as the note of preparation. In the modern or romantic style of composition, all dissonances, under proper con- ditions, especially those; which, on account of their mildness, are allowed to enter free, may be used as notes of preparation to suspensions.* * According to this, uot only the above, but the following examples also are uco-ei it- able. 4.03. In Example 463, the fundamental (at a) and the ffih (at 6) in the diminished triad of B are used as notes of preparation in suspensions. At c and d, the original Jifth in the augmented triads (C, E, Gf and (j^lB/bt) is used in the same capacity, and, like most augmented intervals, it is resolved upward. So also in the Chord of the Aug- mented Sixth, Chord of the Third, Fourth and Augmented Sixth, and Chord of tkd MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. y- \ Fifth and Augmented Sixth, (see pages 127-8), the degree-wise progressing voices n aj serve as notes of preparation to suspensions, according to this modern license, e. r . 4oa. -^ It will also be proper at this point to add examples of various other suspensions which are characteristic of the modern or romantic stj'le of composition. We allude to those whose resolution take place upward, also to double suspensions with a simul- taneous ascending and descending resolution. Suspensions wrrn ascending resolution. Susp. before the fundamental ; before the third : before the fifth : 405. before the fund, and third , 466 the tliird and fifth : the fund, third mnrf fifth. m t 8 5 — 2 3 Suspensions with simultaneous ascending and descending eesoluteon. before the fund : before the third : the fifth-: , , I I I 11 ^"'•i^Ei^E^^^Sil; 7 6 5 3 — Through the adoption into the practical science of Harmony of the above and simi- lar suspensions, a thing which may be unhesitatingly done, inasmuch as they enter and progress as regular dissonance formations, we make a long stride forward in clear- ness, comprehensiveness and freedom ; for, not only all former-used- harmonies, but even the mo.st remarkable combinations and chord-auccessions of our modern music find herein their explanation and vindication. It discovers to the intelligent compos- er an almost inexhaustible mine of new harmonies and successions, establishing theo- retically at the same time the natuKd limits of all the explanable and reasonable dis- sonances which it is possible to form. 172 MAN^UAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Tlie following examples exhibit triple suspensions in connection with the res- olution of the Seventh accord. At a, one of the suspensions is resolved up- ward (B to C), and at h, both D and B are resolved upward. These are the exceptions alluded to in connection with the rule on page 150 (the suspension of the seventh and ninth before the octave) . Both of these suspensions are to be found in classical compositions, but are termed by some theorists, AntAcipa- tion;* i. e., one part of the chord (the Bass, here) appears before the others, thus anticipating what finally occurs. We see no objection to calling these examples suspensions, therefore present them under this head, e. g. a. i h. 4.0S. •t9- ' Similar suspensions can be employed upon the entrance and resolution of most Seventh accords of other construction than the one used in this chapter, provided always that the same conditions are present. The work of the pupil at this point should be to place the Tonic-triad of any chosen key in its open * Anticipation. — In a consonant or dissonant accord thpre sometimes appear one or more foi'eijin tones wliioh acquire an inteUigible harmonic status only in tiie chord immediatelv followinir. Sucli a procedure is termed Anticipation, inasmuch as one or more voices anticipate the tones of, or assume their placea in the now harmony before yr& expect the entire chord, (see ^ in Ex. 409). Their entrance and progression is dejjree or spring-wise at will. Some of the following examjdes are no longer strange, while others might find their vindication only in the peculiar expressioii or voicing sought after in each individual case, such as, for example, passion dominating reason, or stubbornness resisting customary usage, etc. jS. 2; gj: iiiss: ^ i y . i r -i ^ i- MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEORT. 173 and close positions, alternating between the third, fifth and octave as vpper voice, and then effect the entrance of the Dominant-Seventh accord of that key, with suspensions applied to any voice or voices admitting it. Suspensions may afterward be applied to the resolution of this Dominant Seventh accord. Practice in writing and playing these examples in different keys is to be thor- oughly pursued., CHAPTER XXYI. ENTRANCE OF THE DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD AFTER OTHER TRIADS COMMON TO THE SAME MODE. Thus far, we have only shown in what manner the Dominant Seventh accord can enter after the Tonic-triad of the same mode. Inasmuch as this chord can enter free; i. e., spring or degree-wise, it can also enter after every other triad in the same mode, as we shall see in the following examples. For the sake of brevity, we shall present some of the most important examples only, leaving the pupil to further develope the subject by different placing of the voices, and practice in different keys. Having already made use of the Tonic-triad (C major) we will commence here with the entrance of the Dominant Seventh accord, in its Fundamental position, after the triad upon the second degree in the mode of C major, — the triad of D minor (Ex. 470). The mechanical process is the same as in triad- succession: after the position and placing of the voices of the first accord have been determined and written down, the Bass of the Seventh accoi'd should next be added; then, of the remaining voices, write down such as are to be re- tained, and, finally, lead the progressing voices to the nearest tones yet neces- sary to fill out the new accord. It is not to be expected that the pursuance of this simple mechanical rule will always prevent faulty voice-leadings, but it will be found to diminish the liability to faults, and the difficulty of chord-sncces- sion in general. 4.ro. p G7 174 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Examples of the entrance of the Fifth-Sixth and Third-Fourth accords after the same triad (D minor) are to be seen in No. 471. 4.yi. 22:?: m 9h 4 3 m G7 G7 The entrance of the Second accord after D- minor, as at a, Example 472, is not to be recommended, although the process above given is fully carried out. The reason for the bad effect is to be found in the fact that the dissonances (F, Gr and F, B) are approached in similar motion. This should be avoided, where practicable, in order to secure a purer harmonic structure. Contrary motion is the best means thereto, as will be seen at b, where the succession is enth'ely acceptable, although no connecting tone is present, e. g. 4.73. ENTRANCE OF THE DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD AFTER THE TRIAD UPON THE THIRD DEGREE OF THE SAME MODE. Each of the four positions of the Dominant Seventh accord can be easily entered after the triad upon the third degree, the voices of which may be placed with the octave, third or Jifth as Soprano, and in open or close posi- tion, e. g. -473. ^gr:g:-SS- ^= 32= I -zr. 3z: :^iiz; G7 AFTER A TRIAD ON THE FOURTH DEGREE OF THE SAME MODE. Here occurs a chord-succession (F — G) which, in triads, is totally without connecting tones, therefore, one of the cspeciiilly difficult cases. The succes- sion of the P major triad and G major with the additional minor seventh, MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 175 however, yields one connecting; tone, (F) nevertheless, octaves and fiftlis are to be carefully guarded against, e. g. 4L74:. -6i>^ -25r -»- •&- L-3EE53gEEs?^^ 9- • — ^-. 6 5 j2: 2 l-'^^:^- ^ 6 ==~^i^=^ F G7 At N.B. .1, Example 474, the Bass would be faulty if allowed to progress to the upper B, in parenthesis, because the F and B form an unmelodic inter- val (Tritone). The progression is therefore better from F to B below. At N.B. 2, the upper voices are allowed a freer leading for the purpose of secur- ing a firmer close. AFTER A TRIAD UPON THE SIXTH DEGREE. 475. AFTER THE SEVENTH DEGREE. The diminished triad is most acceptable in its Third-Sixth position, and when used four-voiced the third is usually doubled as in the following exam- ples: — 4=76. The example at d (476), although not very good, is certainly better if the Bass commences with the upper D, rather than with that in the parenthesis, as the dissonance (F, G) is best approached in contrary motion. 176 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. CHAPTER XXVII. CONCERNING THE ENTRANCE OF THE DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORDS OF DIFFERENT MODES AFTER ANY CERTAIN SELECTED TRIAD. A NEW CONTRIBUTION TO THE PRE- CEDING TREATISE ON MODULATION. Our next attempts will be to see if any aud every Dominant Seventh accord can enter, with good voice-leading, after a single determined triad. We will choose for this purpose the triad of C major, aud the attempt will be made to enter the Dominant Seventh accord of every other mode after this triad. If the leading of each individual voice cannot be effected in a natural, flow- ing manner, then the whole entrance of the chord must be rejected, (the un- melodic progressions are here, as everywhere, augmented and diminished inter- vals, the major fourth (tritone) and major seventh). In these experiments it will be found that not every position is favorable to the accomplishment of the desired result; with some positions it is possible and with others impossible. The chosen triad may be placed in its Funda- mental, Third-Sixth or Fourth-Sixth position, with the octave, third or Jifth as upper voice, and the attempt then made to enter the desired Dominant Seventh accord in any one of its four positions (', 5, f or f). This, it will be seen, gives a great variety of ways which may be experimented upon. We present here a few examples, and, for the sake of a better survey, we will take each key in chromatic order; for example, the C major triad will be first fol- lowed by a Dominant Seventh accord upon (uot of) C (411). Second, the C major triad will be followed by a Dominant Seventh accord upon Cj^, and so on. The i-esolution in each case will be to the Tonic-triad of the key to which each Dominant Seventh accord respectively belongs. The mechanical process is as follows: — 1. Write down the triad determined upon as the starting-point (C major, here) in any position at will. 2. Write down such tones of the desired Dominant Seventh accord as are common to both chords, if there be any. Remark. — Tones to be chromatically altered must be retained in the Bame voice, (see Ex. 478. See also Cross Eolation, page 110). 3. Cause each progressing voice to move to its place in the Seventh accord by means of a melodic step, and avoid even covered octaves and fifths where possible. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 177 C MAJOR TRIAD FOLLOWED BY A DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD UPON C. 477. At a, Example 417, instead of retaining the E and G in the same voices (Soprano and Tenor), as might have been done, a simple exchange is made, thereby increasing the melodic effect. The same remark applies at h. The other positions may be easily accomplished, our object here being only to indi- cate the process sufficiently clear to aid the pupil in his own experiments. C MAJOR TRIAD FOLLOWED BY A DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD UPON C|^ 4:78. It will be observed that in Example 418, all the tones to be chromatically altered are retained in the same voices. The modulation in Example 418, as well as thfit in many of the following examples, is to be found in modern com- positions only, C MAJOR TRIAD FOLLOWED BY A DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD UPON Dj?. j •" be 479. C Db:7 FOLLOWED BY A DOMINANT SEVENTH ACCORD UPON D. 480. 178 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. The modulation from a Tonic to the Icey of its Dominant occurs very fre- quently, therefore its fuller development here (480). The entrance of the Dom- inant Seventh accord upon D after the other positions and placing of the voices of the C major triad will be found comparatively easy. As this mod- ulation is also, often employed in minor modes, we present a few examples: — -isi. At d, (481) the Seventh accord appears with the fifth omitted, and the fundamental doubled. As already remarked, this is always " allowable and especially so if bad voice-leading is thereby avoided. If the Seventh accord in this case had appeared with all its parts, after this placing of the triad, the voice-leading would necessarily have been as follows: — 483. pj^ ] i JL. ^ II *" t). ^^^^^^^m^^E=^- 1^ 12^1; |^H:^r^- The enharmonic change at N.B. is necessary in order that the modulation may return to Ct}. CHAPTER XXYIIL SECONDARY RESOLUTIONS OF SEVENTH ACCORDS. Heretofore, we have presented only the primary or principal resolution of the Dominant Seventh accord. In the present chapter it is proposed to dis- cuss the other, or, so to speak, secondary resolutions. We will employ for our examples the Dominant Seventh accord of the mode of C major or C minor (Gr, B, D, F), the primary resolution of which is to the triad, C, E, G or C, Eb, Gr. Its resolution to any other triads than these would therefore be called, for the sake of distinction, secondary. The attempt will be made in the following ex- amples to resolve the Seventh accord to all the other triads common to the modes of C major and C minor. The principle already explained on page 162 finds application here also, viz: — A tone which has already been heard loith the dissonant accord, cannot be used immediately afterward as the resolution of any tone of that accord. Therefore, in attempting to resolve a Dominant Seventh accord (it applies as well to all other Seventh accords) into any chosen triad, the tones common to both chords must be used as connecting tones only, and no resolving or progressing voice in the Seventh accord is to be allowed to move to any one of these connecting tones. Consequently, those voices which do progress, must resolve themselves degree-wise to the tone or tones of the triad of resolution not to be found in the Seventh accord. RESOLUTION TO THE TRIAD ON THE SECOND DEGREE. To explain this more clearly, let us attempt to resolve the Dominant Seventh accord in C major (G, B, D, F) to the triad of D minor (D, F, A) situated on the second degree of the C major scale. The mechanical process is as follows- 184 MANUAZ, OF MUSICAL THEORY. 1. Write down the Seventh accord, and, underneath it, place the letters of l'^; triad to which it is proposed to effect a resolution, e. g. _*j 500. 9'— ^- DFA 2. Strike out such letters as are to be found in the Seventh accord, e.g. SOI. ^FA 3. The letters thus stricken out are to be used as connecting tones, e. g. 503. li|*A 4. The remaining letters of the Seventh accord (G and B) are to be re- solved degree-wise to that tone (A) of the triad not common to the Seventh accord, e. g 503. H tSSH |iFA If the G were resolved to F, as in Example 504, it would be a transgression of the above principle, as the F has already been heard in the dissonant ckord: — not. 504=. "^^m i5>- The G is a progressing voice and must therefore resolve degree-wise to a tone not found in its own chord. Each tone of the Seventh accord is either to be bound or resolved degree-wise; no voice, in the secondary resolutions, is allowed to spring. RESOLUTION TO THE TRIAD ON THE THIRD SCALE DEGREE. The resohition of the same Seventh accord to the triad on the tliird scale degree (E minor) is effected in tlie same manner, viz: First, write down the Seventh accord, and, placing the letters of the triad of resolution underneath, strike out such letters as are common to both chords, using these letters its connecting tones; finally, resolve the progressing voices into the letter not Btricken out, e. ^ii<-' Uii. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 185 RESOLUTION TO THE TRIAD ON THE FOURTH SCALE DEGREE. The Slime process is always to be employed ia experimenting with the differ- ent rc'SoUitious of a Seventh accord, and will be fonnd an infallible guide as to what is possible and what is not possible. In this resolution we find only one connecting tone (F), therefore, the progressing voices of the Seventh accord have two tones in the triad to which they can resolve, e.g. 5oe. J'AC The F is bound, the D must resolve to C, the Gr to A, while the B may re- solve to C or A; best, however, to C because B is the leading-tone in the mode of C major. TO THE TRIAD ON THE FIFTH DEGREE. S}=f 5or. ^: ^ It will be seen that all the tones of this triad (G, B, P) are common to the Seventh accord, therefore, all of them must be bound, and no tone remains to serve as a resolulioii for the F. The F cannot resolve to Gr, because that tone has already been heard; neither can it resolve to D, because that would be spring-mse, while a resolution must always take place rfegree-wise. The con- clusion is, therefore, that the triad of G major cannot serve as a resolution of the Dominant Seventh accord upon G. TO THE TRIAD ON THE SIXTH DEGREE. None of the tones of the A minor triad are common to the Seventh accord upon G, consequently all the voices in the Seventh accord are progressing ones. Care, however, is necessary in order to avoid parallel fifths, of which there is a double liabihty here, as there are two fifths contained in the Seventh accord, (see brackets at a, and faulty resolutions at h and c, Ex. 508). h. not : C. not : 508 If the voices of each fifth are led in contrary motion, the faults will be avoided. The G and D (fundamental and fifth) will be resolved as at a, Example 509, and the B and F (third and seventh) as at b. The reunited Seventh accord with its proper resolution is seen at c: — b. 500. 186 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. TO THE TRIAD ON THE SEVENTH DEGREE. :bi)F Again, all the tones of the triad are found common to the Seventh accord, therefore, no resolution can take place, and beside, if the progression loere to take place it would not be a resolution, because the triad is itself dissonant and requires a resolution. By chromatically altering the F, of the diminished triad, to F+t, however, we gain a consonant triad (B, D, F||) which has one tone (Fti) not common to our Seventh accord. The B and D may be bound and the G and F be resolved to Fj| as in Example 511:— 511. JJ|)F$ RESOLUTION TO THE VARIOUS TRIADS IN THE MODE OF C MINOR. The resolutions of the Dominant Seventh accord (the same for both C major and C minor) to the various triads in the mode of C minor which can be cor- rectly accomplished, are presented in Example 512: — Priinaty reso- lution to Tonic- [triad in its Fourth-] To triad on the Primary resolution. ^ Sixth ponition. ^ third degree. To fourth degree. To sixth deg. 512 mmmmm Eb! G Bk I' Afar C AbCEb. The resolution, or rather, going over of the Dominant Seventh accord to the diminished triad on the Second degree of the minor scale, cannot take place because no resolution of the third (B, here) in the Seventh accord is possiljle. The tones D and F, in the present case, may be bound, and the G resolve to Ab, but the B can go neiiher to Ab nor D, for both are more than a degree distant, e. g. not : The resolution to the triads on the fifth and seventh degrees cannot be ef- fected because all the tones of eacli triad are common to the Seventh accord, thus: — Btl jiy MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 18' APPLICATION. Having shown the variety of ways in which a Dominant Seventh accord may be resolved, it is the purpose of the following examples to suggest in what manner these resolutions may be employed in tlie field of modulation. It will be seen that with their aid all of the near related and many of the most for- eign keys can be reached almost instantly, when, if desirable, the new key may be established by means of a cadence similar to those here used. Example 515, shows the entrance of the Dominant Seventh accord to C and its resolution to various triads in the mode of C major, together with suit- able cadences and occasional suspensions: — 515 G7 A -^ G7 Example 516 shows the resolution of the same Dominant Seventh accord to various triads in the mode of C minor, accompanied by cadences. 516. G7 Ah 188 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. The scope of these resolutions may often be extended by simple chromatic alterations. Thus, the example at 6, (515) may be changed to a modulation to E major (see a, Ex. 517);or,that at a, Example 516, may be changed to a modulation to El? minor (see 6, Ex. 517). " I I ! ryvr. ?fe -^-^2 G7 E G7 E|2 The exercise of the pupil at this point should be to select a different Dom- inant Seventh accord, for instance that in the mode of F (C, E, G, B^) and at- tempt resolutions to the various triads in the modes of F major and F minor in the manner indicated on pages 183 — 186. Then these resolutions should be employed in short modulatory phrases, with cadences, similar to those in Examples 515 to 51*1. Other Dominant Seventh accords may then be chosen, upon which to practice the various resolutions, and the subject pursued until fully comprehended. CHAPTER XXIX. DECEPTIVE PROGRESSIONS. (DECEPTIVE CADENCES.) The musical instinct awaits the resolution of every dissonant accord to an- other v/hich is consonant. When, however, a dissonant accord, instead of coming to a point of rest in a consonant accord, goes over (not resolves) to an- other dissonant accord, the procedure is termed a deceptive cadence or pro- gression. Here, as everywhere, the voice-leading must be free from unmelodic steps, parallel fifths and octaves, and cross-relations. In our illustrative ex- amples, we shall make use of the Dominant Seventh accord as in preceding pages, (G, B, D, F), and the proposition will be to follow this accord with the Dominant Scvcuth accord upon various other tones in chromatic order, (C,Cit, D|7, D, etc). If, instead of the cTprcfcd resolution^as at a, Example 518, the tone B in the Seventh accord goes over to the original minor seventh in the second chord, as at b, the result is the forfhation of a new dissonant accord and the progression would be termed a deceptive cadence, e. g. 51S. Ei=g=l G7 C7 ' See foot-note, page IGl. MANXIAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 189 The mechanical process here is very similar to that set forth in counection with the secondary resolutions of a Seventh accord. 1. Having written down the Seventh accord and placed underneath it the letters of the Seventh accord to which it is proposed to attempt the progres- sion, pix)ceed to strike out sucli letters as are common to both chords, e. g. sioS=i= CEGBi 2. Bind or write down the tones common to both chords and those to be chromatically altered, e. g. . 530. ^^= ^^ CE0 B3 3. Progress the other tones degree-wise to their places (to the tones- not stricken out) in the new accord, e. g. 521. CE0Bb It will be found that with some positions of the first accord, the proposed progression cannot be accomplished without faulty voice-leading. AD, positions should be tried, and if all are attended with faults, nothing remsiins but re- jection. The progression from our chosen Dominant Seventh accord to that upon Cj|, the next tone in order, is seen in Example 522: — 533. C$ E$ Gjf ^ While the enharmonic change (F to E|i) may be unob|ectionable in instru- mental compositions, it is not to be recommended in vocaL This distinction is applicable to some other progressions given below. Without pausing to explain the treatment of each example, as in the above^ we give at once, in No, 523, various progressions of the same Dominant Seventh accord to hke accords upon other tones: — 533 Bb? G7 190 MANUAL OF MUSWAL THEORY. Such striking and often harsh sounding chord-successions as we have here indicated are of course peculiar to modern composition, and are not to be em- ployed except where this identical striking effect is sought after. As remarked in connection with the more remarkable ^r?'a^-successions, they are, like spice, to be used sparingly. It will be self-understood that they are not appropriate in compositions of an earnest religious character. We close this chapter by presenting the beginning of a succession of Dom- inant Seventh accords, leaving the student to set forth and complete the exer- cise. The passage begins upon the triad of C major and should end upon this triad,, but, to this end, an enharmonic change will be found necessary at some point in order to finally reach the Cjj again (see further explanation on page 143). The chordr-succession alluded to is to be constructed in the following manner: — All the voices of each Dominant Seventh accord, excepting the third, are .given \k%\x: primary resolution; i. e.: The Bass falls a major fifth; The Seventh falls a diatonic half-step; The Fifth falls a whole-step; The third, however, instead of resolving a half-step upward to the Tonic or Tailing to the fifth as in the primary resolution, /alls a chromatic half-step to the minor seventh of the new fundamental, thereby forming a new Dominant .Seventh accord. When writing this passage four-voiced, ih.Q/fth is of neces- sity omitted in each alternate accord, e. g. 4- 534. m&^^ 9-f^ z^r. JSZ If another voice be added, as in the following example, the fifth may be caused to appear in each accord. 535. J — ^ — '— tfsi — .pis' — ' — A — 91e^^ :=^=^ £ «tc. a- —t^- -^^= MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 191 CHAPTER XXX. CONCERNING OTHER SEVENTH CHORD FORMATIONS. The proposition at present before us is the consideration of all those Seventh accord formations which can arise from the combination of the natural or stem- tones {i.e., without chromatic alterations) of any major or minor mode, — how they may eiiter and progress or resolve. I. A Seventh accord may arise when a subsequent-seventh follows the ()<>- tave or fundamental in a triad, e. g. h. 63G. i :sz § 5 3 -i9- 9fc 4 2 C7 C7 Upon the entrance of this subsequent-seventh (B) the triad (C, E, G) is changed to a Seventh accord, (C, E, G, B). A. subsequent-seventh enters in the character of a passing-note, and, unless the sharp effect given by an accent is specially desired, it is milder unaccented. The resolution of these Seventh accords is effected in the same manner as the Dominant Seventh accord already discussed. The primary resolution will be used in the immediate following examples and the secondary farther on. The primary resolution of the Seventh accord in the example at a, No. 526, will be as follows: — say. ^ ii« C C7 F The Bass (C) falls a major fifth (to F), and upon this tone a consonant triad is to be formed. The seventh (B) therefore falls a degree (to A); the third (E) occurring here as the leading-tone in an outer voice, resolves to the Tonic (to F) and the fifth (G) falls best to the Tonic (to F). If the third (E) had appeared as a middle voice it might have been resolved downward to the fifth of the triad for the sake of the greater fulness, the same as in the Dominant Seventh accord. 192 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. If, now, a subsequent-seventh follow the octave of this triad of resolution (F, A, C), another Seventh accord arises which is to be treated in a similar manner, e. g. 53S. ¥ ^s^ ias J- N.B. Z^ •**^2Z- The triad at N.B., being dissonant, is not to be regarded as a resolution, — although all the voices are moved as in a resolution, — but rather as a pro- gression of the Seventh accord. The tri-tone in the Bass is by itself objec- tionable, but the purpose of this, as well as the use of the diminished triad,wi]l appear in the next example in enabling us, by perpetuating the sequence, to form a passage in which shall appear all the Seventh accords possible to the stem-tones of a major or minor mode, e. g. 539 The above example shows the entrance and progression or resolution of every Seventh accord in the Normal modes of C major and A minor. This ex- ample, as well as those to come, may be easily caused to ajjpear in the similar- named minor mode (C minor) by simply adding the proper signature (three flats here), and using only the stem-tones of that mode (C, d, eb, f, g, ab, hP, C), except in the cadence, in which, according to universal custom, the Dominant- triad with or without seventh should be major, thereby necessitating a chro- matic alteration of its third, e. g. 530. ^:5^^g t^-sn -1 r^ ^ 7 ^^ ■J21 dl -El Bb B|j7 Ei^ Eb? At! Ab? do do7 G G7 C Examples 531, 532 and 533, in major, presenting similar passages com- mencing with different placing of the voices, should be converted into minor as in Example 530, and both major and minor practiced in various keys. AIANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 193 o31. 533. The subsequent-seventh may appear in the Bass after the fundamental of the triad, as in the following example. The resolution however, will be to a Third-Sixth accord. 533. II. ENTRANCE, PROGRESSION AND RESOLUTION OF SEVENTH ACCORDS WITH BOUND SEVENTH. "When the seventh is bound, as in the following example, all Seventh accords may enter, the harshest as well as the mildest: — i © E=r=fS: 534. With the entrance of Seventh accords in this wise, according to classical rule, the seventh is to be treated exactly like any bound dissonance: 1. The bound seventh must have been consonant in the preceding or pre- paration accord. 2. The preparatirm-note or consonance must be as long or longer (not shorter) than the hound seventh or dissonance. 3. The attack of the bound seventh must take place upon an accented meas- ural-division. 194 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 4. The resolution of the seventh must be degree-wise and the whole accord the same as usual. Tlie following examples exhibit the entrance and primary progression or resolution of all the Seventh accords (Fundamental position) with a bound seventh which can be formed with the stem-tones of a Normal major or minor mode. The examples begin with the octave, third and Jifth as upper voice re- spectively. 635. m^ lE^ o & ) ±=t "gjz?"; ^ — -[ — ~ 1— L^ (5^X^_ ^7 7 - -7 — '^ -Sf- -s>~ -J= 4i!- F7 e7 d7 C7 Bo7 a7 G7 — C 636., 537. 7 7 7 — '^ =^ :^i± :d^=c F7 e7 d7 C7 a7 G7 — ^ .ee ^^d=Ei^d=E^'=d={=i ENTRANCE AND RESOLUTION OR PROGRESSION OF BOUND SEVENTH ACCORDS IN THEIR FIFTH-SIXTH POSITION. Making use of the same sequence form as in Example 534, each ^fiad will be succeeded by a Seventh accord in its Fifth-Sixth position, e. g. 63S. The mechanical process succeeding the writing down of the triad is aa fol lows: — MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 195 1. The Bass (the original third) of the Seventh accord is to be first written down. 2. That tone of the triad which is to form the seventh is to be bound. 3. The remaining tones of the triad are to assume the unfilled places in the Seventh accord. It is not to be forgotten that the entrance of the Seventh accord with bound seventh is in all positions to take place accented. If we give the Seventh ac- cord in Example 538, its primary resolution, the fundamental (C) will fall a fifth to F, upon which a triad will appear, e. g. 639. m •6>- 6 5 =-^=' ^ C7 F Xow, if after each triad resolution we cause a new Seventh accord to enter iu the above manner, we shall have a passage giving the entrance and progres- sion or resolution of the Fifth-Sixth position of every Seventh accord possible to the stem-tones of a major or minor mode, e. g 54.0. Examples with different placing of the voices; i. e., with the octave or Jifth as upper voice in each triad, we commence only, leaving it to the pupil tc set forth and finish them, e. g. 54:1. I EE :S: ->&^ iS 12= F7 e7 64:3. 196 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. ENTRANCE AND RESOLUTION OR PROGRESSION OF BOUND SEVENTH ACCORDS IN THEIR THIRD-FOURTH POSITION. The Bass of the Seventh accord will be its original fiffli, the seveiith will oe bound as before, while the two remaining members (fundamental and thv'd) are to be reached from the triad as melodically as possible, e. g. 64.3. ThQ primary resolution {fandamental falls a fifth) will be to the triad of F, e. g. 54-^ 4 3 ^i^ C7 If we perpetuate this sequence the result will be a passage showing the en- trance and resolution or progression of all the Seventh accords, in t^^.eir Third-Fourth position, in a major or minor mode, e. g. 54=S. Examples 546 and 547, with octave and fifth as upper voice of the triad respectively, are to be completed by the pupil: — 54:G. 'i^ss- Ji -jA "4 3 ■i9- ^- =t -e^ a*: _ 'A """^ 4 3 (2^-^ e2. etc. f- F7 e7 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 197 54.7. < ^fe g ?^ g ^ t^==g^F §^ 4 3 etc. F7 e7 ENTRANCE AND RESOLUTION OR PROGRESSION OF BOUND SEVENTH ACCORDS IN THEIR SECOND POSITION. In this case the Bass of the Seventh accord will be the original seventh, therefore, that is the voice to be bound. In order to have the bound seventh to appear as the Bass, it is necessary that the same tone shall have been the Bass in the preparation triad. Thus, in the same succession which we have previously used in the illustrative examples (Nos. 534, 538 and 543), viz: G major triad and the Seventh accord, (C, E, G, B), the seventh (B) must have been the Bass in the triad of G, thereby causing that triad to ap- pear in its Third-Sixth position preparatory to the entrance of the Seventh accord alluded to, e. g. 548. The voice-leading in the entrance of the Seventh accord in the above posi- tion should be as follows: — 1. Bind the seventh. 2. Lead that voice of the triad which can most naturally move to the fun- damental of the Seventh accord. 3. Cause the remaining tones of the triad to assume the still vacant places in the Seventh accord. The primary resolution of the Seventh accord will take place when the- fundamenlal falls a fifth, upon which new tone a consonant triad is ^rmed, e. g. 549. m s C7 F Inasmuch as the preceding resolution (Ex. 549) yielas another Third-Sixth accord; its Bass oan again be bound and become the seventh of a new Seventh 198 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. accord. Continuiug ia this manner, a passage will be formed exhibiting the entrance and resolution or progression of the second position of all the Seventh accords common to the stem-tones of a major or minor mode, e. g. 550. d7 G C7 F B=7 E a7 A similar passage may be formed with the fifth as upper voice of the triads. The pupil should complete the following example: — 551. FURTHER TREATMENT OF BOUND SEVENTH ACCORDS. ENTEANCE OF THKEE DIEFEKENT BOUND SEVENTH ACCOKDS AETEE A SINGLE DETEBMINED TEIAD. Thus far the bound Seventh accord has each time entered in the same man- ner, i. e., by the fundamental of the preparation-triad falling a fiftii. Thus, the same tones in each example have served as bound sevenths. We remark now that each tone of any triad (lii fundamental, third, fifth or octave) may be used as the hound seventh in a following Seventh accord. I. For example, if the fundamental of a triad be chosen as the tone to be bound, then that tone is the first to be written down, e. g. 553. is: ^•: 2 The chord, of which the bound tone (C) is the seventh, is composed of the tones D, F, A, C, consequently, the three remaining voices in the triad (So- prano, Alto and Tenor) are to be led as melodically as possible to the three tones (D, F, A — ) necessary to complete the Seventh accord, (see o, Ex. 553.) The leading at b is not so good on account of the covered fifths. The pri- mary resohition is given in the following examples. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 199 653. :f=l 6 d7 G d7 II. If the third (E) of the triad of C major be bound and used as the seventh in a following Seventh accord, that chord will be composed of the tones F, A, C, E. As before, first write down the tone which is to become the seventh, then such tones, if there be any, as it is possible to retain, and, final- ly, progress the remaining voices to the still vacant places in the Seventh ac- cord. Different positions of the same Seventh accord are shown in Ex. 554, 554.. ^=^ :^ Eg^-H- g :-fc-^E^=; :??: 9^ -\ — -1 3 -<9- -I CF7b° ___ ___ III. Again, if i\iQ fifth (G) in the triad of C major is used as the bound seventh in a following Seventh accord, that accord will consist of the tonei A, C, E, Gr. Its entrance in different positions is given in Ex. 555. — — L/5J e^^ — ■ — -o 1 -^ c^ — J 555. 4 3 t -■ C a7 D — — — — lY. Finally, if the octave (C) in the triad of C major is used in the same capacity, the Seventh accord will be formed of the tones D, F, A, C, e. g. 556. Cd7G ____— — The exercise of the pupil at this pomt should be to place the same triad we have here used (C major) with the third or fifth as upper voice, and in turn 200 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. use each voice as the bound seventh in a following Seventh accord. We give, in Ex. 551, the beginning of these exercises leaving the pupil to fill out the Seventh accords and add the primary resolution to each. 55 Having worked out the above exercises, other major and minor triads should be used in the same way. It will readily be seen what a wide and important field is thus opened. ENTRANCE OF A SINGLE DETERMINED BOUND SEVENTH ACCORD AFTER THREE DIFFERENT TRIADS. In the above, three different bound Seventh accords (d7, Ft, a7) were caused to enter after tlie same triad (C major). As antithesis to this, a single deter- mined bound Seventh accord may enter after three different triads, or after as many triads as contain that tone which is to become the bound seventh in tlie Seventh accord. To illustrate this we will make use of the Seventh accord which stands on the first degree of the scale of C major, (C, E, G,B). The seventh (B) is to be found in three different triads common to the mode of C major, — a,?, fifth in the triad of E minor, as third in that of G major, and as fundamental in that of B diminished. It follows therefore, that the B in each one of these triads can be bound, and, by proper leading of the other voices, become the seventh in a following Seventli accord. The mechanical process is the same here as with the entrance of all bound Seventh accords, e.g. 558, In the same manner the Seventh accords upon every other degree of the scale (see page 159) may each enter after the tiiree different triads wliich chance to contain the tone, which, by being bound, may become the seventh in one of these Seventh accords. We give one more example (559) using that Seventh accord which stands upon the second degree of the scale of C major, — (D, F, A, C). Tlie seventh (C) of this chord is found common to the triads of C major, F major and A minor, therefore, each one of these may be used as a preparation-triad to the same bound Seventh accord, e. g. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEORT. 201 659. -4 =^=ig=#=t^2=Igz=|=:ti^=:i.2=i:; :s=?=: :^ d7 d7 d7 C/ti^T^lo It is suggested to the student to attempt the entrance of the Seventh ac- cords upon the remaining degrees of the scale (see page 159) in the manner set forth above. SECONDARY RESOLUTIONS OF THE FOREGOING SEVENTH ACCORDS. In connection with the Dominant Seventh accord many diflerent resolutions of the same accord were exhibited, one of which was termed primary, and all the rest secondary. What was said there is only to be repeated here. A bound Seventh accord is capable of being resolved to every triad com- mon to its own mode, (also to some triads foreign to its own mode, though these latter naturally belong to the romantic style of composition), excepting such as are contained in the Seventh accord itself. The same as with the Dominant Seventh accord, the pupil can make these experiments himself and prove satisfactorily which resolutions are possible and which are not. We take for example, the Seventh accord (C, E, G, B) and the attempt will be made to resolve it to each of the triads common to the mode of C major. Eemaek. — As the Seventh accord M-e hp.ve chosen cannot enter /cee, the ties will in- dicate its supposed preparation by means of a precediug accord. 560. ^^-.--^-r •iE^ssiiiiiS <2pG DFA |:tJB FAt! C3:pD &. (p ^ PDF The resolution of this Seventh accord to the triads of C major and E minor cannot be eifected, because all the tones of these triads are 'contained in the Seventh accord, (see principle and process laid down, pages 183-5). The pu- pil should now make the same experiments with the other Seventh accords common to the mode of C major. APPLICATION OF SEVENTH ACCORDS IN CADENCES. Instead of cadences formed entirely of triads, we are now able to employ Seventh accords also. We have already learned that upon the Sub-dominant we may use either a Third-Fifth {%) or Third-Sixth {%) accord. If we merge these two chords into one, a Fifth-Sixth accord (a Seventh ac- cord in its Fifth-Sixth position) is the result, e. g. K '^-i->uy 202 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY, 561.^' =JQ$^, This Seventh accord, the Fifth-Sixth position of that Seventh accord upon the second degree of the scale of C major, may appear in a cadence in the following wise, (N.B, Ex. 562). N.B. ses. ZSH d7 As the Seventh accord above used does not contain a diminished triad it cannot enter free. It must therefore be bound, as here, or enter as a subse- quent-seventh, as in Ex, 563, (N.B). The primary resolution is used here. N.B. 5e3. Pe :zE. -7 Example 564, presents another form of the above (563) and also a Seventh accord upon the Dominant : 564.. We have shown in a previous chapter how two Seventh accords can sue- ceed each other. This may be eiFected here in the following manner, with or without the chromatic alteration, (Afz) which altered tone occurs iu the minor Sub-dominant-triad (F, Al?, C), e. g \ ■El m ses. \ ite 6 5 •7T 7 12: MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 203 The following examples in minor are to be filled out by the pupil in the same manner as the foregoing in major : 5Ge. 6 5 t lie -—^ 1=^ In the following cadence it will be seen that the Seventh accord upon the Sub-dominant is resolved to the Tonic-triad in its Fourth-Sixth position (N.B). The unfinished examples are to be worked out by the pupil. SOT. If any proof were necessary as to the correctness of the above resolution, (N.B.) the same infallible test may be apphed as heretofore explained, e.g. 568. (3 EG All of the above cadences are to be thoroughly exercised in all keys, both in writing and playing. SUCCESSION OF SEVENTH ACCORDS. I. If the seventh in a Seventh accord be regularly resolved a degree down- wards while at the same time all the other voices remain in their places, a new Seventh accord arises. This may be termed a deceptive cadence, e. g. 560. ^=3 •or- ^m F7 d7 204 ifANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. If, now, the original seventh (C) of the second Seventh accord (d7) be re- solved a degree downward, while the other voices remain in their places, anoth- er Seventh accord will arise (N.B., Ex. 510). If this process is set forth, the re- sult will be a passage of continuous Seventh accords, each of which will be prepared by its preceding Seventh accord (see Ex. 5T0). It is to be under- stood that each successive accord, in the following exercises, is to remain in the same mode as its predecessor so that the original mode may not be depart- ed from : — I ^^ I N.B. -J. J- sro. ^ (m ^3^1i5S»i^te^iJ -i9- 1 — • -S>-\-iSf- m -^ =^^=3=:< C F7 d7 b°7 G7 e7 C7 a7 r7 d7 b"? G7 — C Each Seventh accord in the above enters with a bound seventh, answering therefore to the strongest classical rules. This and the following similar ex- amples may be produced in C minor by applying the proper signature and us- ing a major Dominant accord in the cadence (see Ex. 530 on page 192). The exercise should also be worked out with octave or Jifth as upper voice in the commencing triad. It will be noticed that each successive accord appears in a diiferent position. Example 571, shows that the Fundamental position could not be used continuously, on account of the too perceptible octaves. 571. F7 d7 II. If the fifth and seventh in a Seventh accord are allowed to fall a de- gree each, while tb? other voices remain in their places, a new Seventh accord with bound seventh arises, e. g. 57a. If the original fifth and seventh in the second Seventh accord (b®7) are allowed to fall again a degree, the result is another Seventh accord with bound seventh, and so on, ad libitum. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 205 :=J^ 573. In the above example (S'TS) tlie Seventh accoi'ds appear alteiMiately in the Fundamental and Third-Fourth position. The following example presents the same succession, using only the Fundamental position ; the fifth is necessarily omitted in each alternate accord, e. g. ^^m 574. If a fifth voice be added, as in the following example, each Seventh accord will appear with a 'full complement of voices. 575. f^m r^z L -Si i=^E 7 -^1 :s: F7 B°7 e7 a7 d7 G7 C III. If the third, fifth and seventh of a Seventh accord are caused to fall a degree while the fundamental remains in its place, the result is another Seventh accord with bound seventh, e. g. 576. F7 G7 a7 b°7 G7 This manner of Seventh accord succession does not permit working out fur- ther than N.B., at which point the cadence begins. The same succession commencing with the fifth as upper voice in the prepa- 206 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. ration-triad, may be set forth just as far as the preceding (N.B.),bnt beyond that point faults arise if three voices are caused to fall at once, e. g. N.B. 57"7. Commencing with the third as upper voice in the preparation-triad, and faults arise immediately (see Ex. 578.) The two positions preceding (Exam- ples 576 and 577) are the only ones usable when three voices fall simultane- ously. 578. F7 G7 Thorough practice of Examples 5Gy to 577 in writing and playing in all the different keys should here follow, to the end that these most vigorous of disso- nant accords may be perfectly understood and practically in hand. In compositions of the present day they are less and less employed, chiefly on account of the difficulty of their manipulation., therefore, all the more reason for their careful study. SEVENTH ACCORD UPON THE LEADING-TONE OF A MAJOR MODE. . The treatment of that Seventh accord which occurs upon the leading-tone of a major mode demands a few remarks. In the key of C major this Seventh accord consists of the tones (B, D, F, A) and its intervals are fx, minor third, minor fifth and minor seventh. Its most natural resolution is. to the Tonic-triad of its own mode, and, when given that resolution, the position of this Seventh accord is most acceptable when the original neventh appears as upper voice, e. g. 570. iiE: ^am The entrance of this chord is/ree, inasmuch as it contains a diminished tri- ad, and its entrance after any triad in its own mode is not difficult enough to MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 207 require any remark excepting that after the Tonic-triad. With this entrance, faults easily arise, to avoid ■\vliich, tlie following is to be observed. First of all, in order that the Seventh accord may appear with the original seventh as upper voice, the Tonic-triad will be best arranged if Ms fifth is the upper voice, as in the succeeding examples. If the Fundamental position of the Seventh accord is to enter after this triad, it will be found necessary to double the third of that triad {a, b, Ex. 580) in order to avoid the faults alluded to, — parallel fifths as at c, Ex. 580. The same is to be remarked concerning the resolution back to the Tonic-triad, e. g. 5 so. r§ 1 I ». c not : fh\ -^ ' '^ - ^ l^_,_J^-l^-=j 7 ^-.sTs^ 1 L-^ 7 f5> J:^ ^^^ ^:^ ' y' i? — ^ 'S' . >s — S> 84. CHAPTER XXXI. THE DIMINISHED SEVENTH ACCORD. We have already alluded many times to the milder major mode, i e.,.a ma- jor mode with a minor sub-dominant-triad. If the Seventh accord standing on the leading-tone of the Normal major mode ap- pear,arranged according to this milder mode, it will consist of the tones B,D, F, A^7, and contain as intervals a minor third, viinor fifth and diminished seventh. Taking its name from the last mentioned interval tlie combination is denomin- iited as above. This Seventh accord can be used equally well in all positions, and, on account of containing a diminished triad (two such in. fact), it is allow- ed to enter free. Its positions are as follows: — MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 209 5S5. ENTRANCE. A few remarks in conaection with its entrance after the Toaic-triad will be sufficient to indicate the manner of its entrance after other triads. In Example 586, the entrance at a, though sometimes used, is not to be recommended on account of the fifths, notwithstanding the fact that the second is a minor fifth* By doubling the third of the triad, the leading, in the entrance of the Seventh accord, will be purer, (6), e. g. ^ 586. < ~^^m 587. 7 ^§s; ZSL ZSZ 13_^E3^ b7 zsn In accordance with the voice-leading discussed above, the resolution of the Fifth-Sixth, Third-Fourth and Second positions of the Diminished Seventh ac^ cord will be as follows: — 593.^ -^6^- ':sc ^^ -^ i gg 'i 6 b5 (6) L-^/n 1 In order to facilitate the resolution of a Diminished Seventh accord, the seventh may be lowered a diatonic half-step resulting in a Dominant Seventh accord, e. g. 593. -6f- -5" — 4 4 -zJ— ^ I22Z IS Hit: Upon the leading-tone in a minor mode a similar Diminished Seventh accord may appear. The conditions of its entrance and resolution are precisely the game as those already discussed. MAyUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 211 Similar-named modes have one and tlie same Diminished Seventh accord, as seen in Example 594. Its most natural resolution is to the Tonic-triad of either mode, e. g. ^^^ (S* — \—i2— The resolution of the Fifth-Sixth, Third-Fourth and Second positions to the minor triad will be as follows: — 505. ,664 The entrance of the Diminished Seventh accord upon the leading-tone of the mode of A minor after the Tonic-triad, and its renolutioii to the same chord is shown in Examples 596 and 597. 506. 59r. I. A Diminished Seventh accord, in whatever position it is placed, (?, g,*, or a) is formed of tones which, in sound, stand in minor thirds one above the other. These same tones may be written in a variety of ways, but in sound they pre- sent only the interval of minor thirds. This ambiguity especially adapts tliis chord to the field of Modulation. In the following table, the i'ame sounds are so written as to present four different Diminished Seventh accords. Their fundamental are seen in the first line of letters underneath, and in the next line, the fundamentals of the respective Tonic-triads, major and minor, to which the Seventh accord will most naturallv resolve: — ■ SOS .i^= iHiS C maj: C mill. Gjf 212 MAXUAI. OF MUSICAL THEORY. The object of this alteration is as follows: — The Diminished Seventh accord always stands upon the leading-tone of a major or minor mode, therefore, in order to resolve it to the Tonic-triad of any chosen mode, the combination of tones forming the Seventh accord should be so written as to cause it to stand upon the leading-tone in that mode to which it is proposed to resolve. Thus, if we desired to resolve the combination of tones at a, Example 598, to the Tonic-triad of A major or A minor we should vjrite them as at h, of the same example. The fundamental in that case would be Gj;[, which is the leading- tone in the modes of A major and A minor, and the chord so written would most naturally resolve to the Tonic-triad of those modes. The same sounds written, as at c or d, resolve to still different triads, so that in all, a total of eight different resolutions becomes possible through these simple enharmonic changes, or, in other words, each member or sound in a Diminished Seventh accord can be regarded as the leading-tone to some major or minor mode, and the chord so written, without changing its sound, as to enable it to resolve naturally into four diflferent major and four different minor Tonic-triads. To illustrate this more perfectly we will make use of the Diminished Seventh accord, in the above table, in a few modulations, and first, as written at a, To make the modulation more decided, the original seventh will each time be lowered a diatonic half-step, resulting in a Dominant Seventh accord, e. g. 509. In the above example, the Diminished Seventh accord is so written as to cause it to stand upon 'the leading-tone (B) in the modes of C major or C mi- nor. Its resolution is therefore most natural to the Tonic-triads of those modes. Again, if the Diminished Seventh be written as at h, Ex. 598, Git, B, D, F), its fundamental (G||) will be the leading-tone in the modes of A major or minor; the modulation in the following example will consequently be from C major to A major or minor, e. g. eoo. < MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. 213 Agaia, if tlic tone F of the chord, as at a, Example 589, be regarded as a leading-tone, it will be found necessary to write the chord as at c, in the same example, (E^, Gj:f, B,D), in order to use the same sounds with that leading- tone as the fundamental. The Diminished Seventh accord expressed in this wise will most naturally resolve to the Tonic-triads of Fjj: major or minor, Ej| being the leading-tone in those modes, e. g. 601. $ ite Finally, if the next to the lowest tone of the chord at a, Ex. 598, be con- sidered as a leading tone, and used as the fundamental of a Diminished Seventh accord, the chord will necessarily be expressed by the letters (D, F, Al?, Cb), and as D is the leading-tone in the modes of Elz major or minor, the resolu- tion to the Tonic-triads of those modes will naturally follow, e. g. 603. iiEE 2Cl- ■-^- As will be seen from the foregoing examples, four different Diminished Seventh accords, — composed of the same sounds, however, — each in a different position, may enter after the same triad and resolve to four different keys. TIuis far we have used only the most natural resolution of the Diminished Seventh accord. We remark now that other resolutions are possible. II a. Any tone of a Diminished Seventh accord can be bound and the oth- er tones of the Seventh accord resolved to that minor triad of which this hound tone is the fundamental. For example, if the F in the chord at a, Example 598, be bound, and the chord resolved to that minor triad of which F is the fundamental, the lead- ing will be as in the following example: — 603. ^'^1? 214 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. Our mechanical process comes again into application. The letters common to the Seventh accord and the triad of resolution are to be stricken out and these tones first bound; after which, the, progressing voices are to resolve de- gree-mse to their places in the new chord. In the present case, therefore, the tones F and A|; are to be bound and the B and D must resolve to the re- maining tone of the triad (C). The triad of resolution here appears in its Fourth-Sixth position, consequently, if it be proposed to estabhsh that key it Is necessary to add the remainder of the cadence, as above. 116. Any tone of a Diminished Seventh accord can be bound and the oth- er tones resolved to that major triad of which this bound tone is the funda- mental. As an illustration, we will bind the same tone (F) as in the preceding ex- ample, and the present resolution will be to that major triad of which F is the fundamental (F, A, C). In resolving a dissonant accord, those tones which are to be chromatid cally altered are to be retained in the same voice. Cross-relations easily arise if this rule is not adhered to. In the resolution of the Seventh accord, B, D, F, Ab, to the major triad, F, A, C, the F will be bound, the AJ2 changed iu the same voice to Ajj, and the B and D resolved to C, e. g. 604. ^E^ ibi: jE ^ ^^Ei \n 6 4 §iB= Inasmuch as the Ab in the above Diminished Seventh accord is the dissonant proper, (original seventh), and is here resolved vpivard to A^f, it is deemed more correct by some to write this tone as G||, (see following example), as the tendency in the resolution of aflat is downward, while that of a sharp is iipwai^d. Tliis is often iudeed a guide to correct nutation, but we are al- ways permitted to chromatically alter a tone, tliercby not changing its staff- degree, as in the above case, without violating rules or good sense. We present both notations, however, remarking that both are correct. eo5. ^AC MANUAL OF MUSICAL TUFORY. 215 Although no universal rule can be given, yet, if tlie following be observed, the notation cannot be far from correct: — A Diminished Seventh accord is to be written in that way which will best preserve its connection with its preceding and succeeding accord. Thus, in the present case, if the triad of C minor preceded, we should most certainly write A|2 in the Diminished Seventh accord, because that tone is common to the mode of C minor, while G|:| would be entirely foreign. If C major precedes, as here, then either Ab or G| may be used with equal propri- ety since neither are common to the mode of C major. If we bind D, in the same Seventh accord, to become the fundamental of a triad of resolution, the leading will be, as follows, to a major or minor triad at will, e. g. 606. PFA If A? be bound as the fundamental of a minor triad of resolution the lead- ing will be to Af , CI?, E[?, e. g. eo7. The bracket in Example 607, calls attention to the enharmonic change (Bto C'b). This is to be avoided Avherever possible, therefore, in the present case instead of B, in the Diminished Seventh accord, it is decidedly better to write Cb, e.g. eos. ^h«.'bEb The Seventh accord here resolves to a Third-Sixth accord. The resolution to a Fourth-Sixth accord may be gained, as in previous examples, by simply 216 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEORT. changing the position of the Seventh accord until it is so situated as to allow it to resolve degree-wise into such a triad, for example : — _^ ^' 7!^: is: B7 In the Diminished Seventh accord here, we have written Gti instead of A|2 for the reason that Git lies in nearer connection with the mode of the chords following ; the Alz would have been quite foreign. It will be found practical to first write down the tone to be bound, and, having considered of what tones the Dominant Seventh accord will be composed upon this bound tone as fun- damental, then write the Diminished Seventh accord in that way which will best preserve its connection with the preceding and following accords. If the G|| in the same Diminished Seventh accord be bound and the remain- iiig tones raised a half-step the result will be the Dominant Seventh accord Gjt, B||, D||, FJI, which resolves primarily to the triads of C|J! major or minor, e. g. eia./ G«7 218 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. In Example 61 3, A7, instead of Gfi, is regarded as th^ fundamental of a Dominant Seventh accord. The chord, therefore, consists of the tones At?, C, P-^l?, Gb.. and resolves to Dl? major or minor, e. g. G13. 9- I57 -ffi! t25 •-i9- ,(b) ^: Ab7 If D, of the same Diminished Seventh accord, be bound and become the fundameMal of a Dominant Seventh accord through the elevation of the oth- er voices a half-step, that Dominant Seventh accord will consist of the tones D, F||, a, C, and naturally resolve to G major or minor, e. g. ei4.. Finally, if F be bound and the reraainin'g voices progressed a half-step up- ward, the result will be the Dominant Seventh accord, F, A, C, Eb. Its pri- mary resolution is to the triad of Bb major or minor, e. g. 015. 9=: >^, F7 We have, so far, caused the same Diminished Seventh accord and its enhar- monic metamorphoses to enter after the triad of C major, and we have succeed- ed by means of the three methods of treating this one accord (see I, II, III), in eflecting modulations to every one of the twelve major and twelve minor keys. From this, it will at once be seen what a potent agent this accord con- stitutes in flic field of Modulation. It will also be seen that thorough (exer- cise in writing and playing should here follow, and to the end that the subject may be made still clearer we will choose another triad than C major, afttT which, to enter and resolve a Diminished Seventh accord. I. We will t;ikc, for example, the triad of C^ minor, and, having caused the Diminished Seventh MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 219 accord which stands upon the loadhig-tone of this modetoenter (Ij|:f,Di|,F^,A), we will first regard each tone in turn as the leading-tone to a major or minoi Tonic-triad. If the Diminished Seventh accord be so ^vritten as to stand upon BJ^ as its fundamental, it will most naturally resolve to the triads of Cj^ major or mi- nor, e. g. ct—ct 616. ^=^ -rii^i^ m ^ -^- Regarding Dji as a leading tone, the Seventh accord will be written T)^, F*^, A, C, and will resolve to that major or minor key in which Dji is the leading-tone, — to E major or minor, e. g. c«-E. 61 Having modulated from C^ minor to E major, the next proposition, for the sake of practice as well as the musical effect, will be to modulate back to the starting-point again (Cji). This is to be effected by means of the Diminished Seventh accord which stands upon the leading-tone of E major, (D^,FJ};,A,C), that being the triad from which the return modulation begins. The modula- tion will be shortened if this Diminished Seventh can be so enharmonicaUy changed as to cause it to stand upon the leading-tone of the objective key (C^). Of the chord Dti, Fj:|, A, C, only one tone need be enharmonicaUy clianged to secure the chord desired, (C to B^). The Diminished Seventh accord will then consist of the tones Bi|,D|i,Fit,A, and will therefore resolve naturally to Cti major or minor, e. g. " E— c$. 618. 3g: 9- _*r^ In changing "a Diminished Seventh accord enharmonicaUy, as here, so as to adapt it to leading into a following chord, due care must be taken that the enharmonic change does not produce unnatural voice-leading for the chord preceding. 220 MAIfUAL OF MUSICAL TEEORT. Example 619, at a, uses the F^ as a leading-tone, and, through a Diminish- ed Seventh accord upon that tone, a modulation is effected to G major or mi- 4or. The return from G major to Clt minor is effected by means of a Dimin- Lshed Seventh accord upon F|t, the leading-tone in G major. The chord ia formed of the letters Fji, A, C, Eb, but by enharmonically changing the Eb to DJI and C to Bj:f, we shall have the Diminished Seventh accord Bji, D^, FjiA, which leads directly to C|f minor, (h) CJJ— G, N.B. eio. The Djif, atN.B.,(619) should properly beEb,if F^ is considered as the/wnt^a- mental, of the Seventh accord, (Fjj;, A,C,Eb), but if Eb were used here, the voice-leading in the Soprano (see bracket) would then be Cit to Eb, a dimin- i>^hed third, therefore an unmelodic progression. We are, consequently, com- pelled to write the accord as above. If we use A, of our Diminished Seventh accord, as a leading-tone, the chord will be A, C, Eb, Gb, and resolve to Bb major or minor. The immediate en- trance of this chord after the triad of C^ minor would contain unnatural pro- gressions, hence the enharmonic changes (D|| to Eb and Gb to F|f) in the fol- lowing example, (620), at a. The modes of Ctt minor and Bb major are six relative degrees apart, therefore, if such a distant modulation is to be effected through one chord only, it is to be expected that more than ordinary means will be employed thereto. The return modulation (Bb — c|;) is made through the Diminished Seventh accord upon A, the leading-tone in Bb major ; such changes are made as are necessary to resolve it directly to Cjj! minor, (6). a. 030. U Bb— cj. b. =ff=^1; 2i=Ja=--lt?E=:* 1; ;£ t '-^- Of course there is no absolute necessity of using such abrupt modiilationa as in Example 020, for the same keys could be reached according to the more natural methods already described. The proposition here was to regard each member of the Diminished Seventh accord (1>||, DjJ, l''^, A) as a leading-tone, and then resolve tlie accord to the Tonic-triad of that major or minor mode to which the chosen leading-tone belonged. This necessitated the above example MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 221 II. According to this method of treatment (see pages 213-16) each tone of the Diminished Seventh accord will in turn be regarded o.^ fundamental of a major or minor triad to which triad tlie other tones will resolve. If we were to bind B|:|, the triad of resolution would be Bti, Dx, Fx, a Tonic-triad which is never used. We therefore take CJ3, (the enharmonic substitute of Bi|) and, binding that, resolve the other tones ( — Dj|, Ftt, A) of the Diminished Seventh accord to the major triad of which C is the funda- mental (cTeTg). 631. fefel^=g^i= -/SI • SlE -W- -A^ The modulation from C major back to Cji minor is to be effected by means of the Diminished Seventh accord standing upon the leading tone to C ma- jor, — B,D,F,Al7. As Ab, hawever, is quite foreign to the objective key, its enharmonic substitute (G||) should be used here. Of the chord B, D, F, G||, the G^ may be bound as the fundamental of the Dominant Seventh accord to CJI minor, th e oth er tones (B, D, F — ) being raised a half-step to complete the chord, G'^Bjf, D|Fj|;, (HI, pages 211-18). This accord leads direct to the new key, e. g. 633. giE__g?Z!^_^,^ euenth and minor ninth, and,from the last interval, is termed in most text books, CHORD OF THE MINOR NINTH, the figuring is usually given as follows: — i or 7 or ba. Many rules have H 3 7 been given for its entrance, progression and inversion, and the matter in vari- ous ways made complicated and obscnre. Such a combination is regarded in this work as an ORGAN-POINT FORMATION. The theory of its being a chord formation, in the i)ro})er sense of that term, is to be totally rejected. That which is to be rationally acknowledged as a determined chord-formation, and therefore entitled to a determined name, is a combination of tliree or four tones, which, in I heir closest possible position with the fundamental as Bass, stand only third-ioi.se above each other. As such, wo recognize only triads and seventh-accords, with their respective ip- MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 229 versions. An accord-formation in its close position never exciHils an octave in compass. Tlie above combination or seemivg accord, G, B, D, F, Al?, is not in its closest position, for tlie Ajz may be placed an octave lower vfithout going be- low the regarded fundamental (G), thus, still farther condensing the arrange- ment of the tones, so that they do 7iot stand third-wise one above the other, e.g. 64=3. Therefore, as just remarked, the combination is to be regarded as an organ- point, the Bass (G) being the sustained tone and the upper voices a Diminish- ed Seventh accord. The treatment of the upper "herd is exactly the same as already discussed. Whatever has been done previously with the entrance, progression or resolu- tion of a Diminished Seventh accord is equally capable of performance here, only remembering that the last chord in the organ-point must form an intelligi- ble harmony (i.e., an acknowledged chord formq,tion) with the sustained tone. Kemark. — ^It should be remarked here that greater freedom is allowed, in modem compositions, in the entrance of an organ-point. Thus, while according to the strict- er rules of classic composition, only triads and the mild dissonances, to which the sustained tone is common, may begin an organ-point, we are allowed in these freer rules to begin such a formation with the harsher triads and Seventh accords to which the sustained tone is sometimes iiot common. Examples are seen in the following pages. At a, Example 643, we give the ordinary resolution of the Diminished Seventh accord, B, D, F, Ab, — to C, E, G, an intelligible harmony with the sustained tone. At b, the ninth is caused to fall a diatonic half-step, resulting in a Dominant Seventh accord, and at c, the third in the upper chord is omit- ted, thereby making the organ-point four-voiced, e,.g. a. b. c. V — ■ 643. We have spoken of that Seventh accord which stands upon the leading-tone in a major mode, (pages 206-8). If this accord (in the mode of C major, B,D,F, A,) appear above the Dominant (G) of the same mode, there arises the so-called CHORD OF THE MAJOE NINTH. 230 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY, It coutaiiis as intervals, a tliird, fifth, seventh and major ninth, taking its name from the last. Its fift-uriu"^ is given as follows: — 644.. 9:=! This combination is just as little a chord-formation as is the so-called cliord of the Minor Ninth, (see above). It is simply an organ-point in which Gr is the sustained tone. The treatment of the upper chord is the same as that al- ready explained, (pages 206-8), and its effect is best with the original seventh as upper voice, e. g. a. h. not: c. better: 645. The resolution at b, Example 645, although sometimes used, is certainly not correct, because the organ-point does not end with an acknowledged chord- formation. Through the aid of a fifth voice, as at c,the end is correctly effect- ed the same as at a. The third of the upper chord may be best omitted if the organ-point is to have only four voices. That none of the combinations referred to at the beginning of this chapter are chord-formations, is proven in the fact that they cannot be inverted, as is the case with triads and Seventh accords. For example, the so-called chord of the Major Ninth may be made, by inversion, to assume the following com- bination, which is striking if nothing more, e. g. 646. ^ :^2^^ The following example (647) appears to be an inversion of the so-called Chord of the Major Ninth, with the original third of the upperchord omitted. This apparent inversion is caused by the sustained tone being used as a middle- voice; therefore, the procedure, as before, Is an organ-point. 647. -jsr =!25=3=i=3 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 231 It will be self-understood thut any other tone tliiin the Dominant can be us- ed as the sustained tone, over which can appear any one of the combinations treated in this chapter. When the Dominant Seventh accord of any major or minor mode appears over the Tonic of the same mode there arises the so-called CHORD OP THE ELEVENTH. Its intervals are Ql fifth, seventh, ninth and eleventh, and its figuring is usu- ally given as follows: — 11 9 11 64.S C^' 1 *"7. J • -^ r^ ^ '^ 1 . This is simply an organ-point similar to the previously-named combinations. The upper chord is to be treated like any chord of the Dominant Seventh. At 6, Example 649, the fifth in the upper chord is omitted, the member least missed when the organ-point appears four-voiced, e. g. 64.9. THE SO-CALLED CHORD OF THE THIRTEENTH is simply an organ-point consisting of two sustained tones, — a Tonic and Dom- inant, -above which, appear either of the Seventh accords used in Examples 643 and 645. The treatment is as usual with those chords, e. g. 650. e^i^IeIe^^s #-'-^- Dom. \ZJZZZ g= j=a^^-g= q Ionic. This organ-point may appear as at h, — with one of the sustained tones (Dom.) and the third oi the upper chord omitted. The figuring of the above combination is usually given as follows: — 65] 13 11 9 13 13 7 9 11 13 5 7 7 7 C\' 1 *-l. 1 ^ /=/ ^ '* - 1 232 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. To further show the reasonableness of regarding the foregoing combinations as simply organ-points, we present in Example 652, a Dominant Seventh ac- cord as upper harmony to which, with equal propriety, we may apply, as sus- tained tone, the Tonic, third or fifth of the same mode. At a, the so-called Chord of the Eleventh arises ; at h, that of the Ninth, and at c, the ordinary Dominant Seventh accord with doubled /tmc?ar?ie?ifai, e. g. 652. To a Diminished Seventh accord upon the leading-tone, for example, that upon Gjt in the mode of A minor, may be applied as sustained tone the Tonic, third or fifth of the same mode. The result is the so-called Chords of the Thirteenth, Eleventh and Ninth, respectively, e. g. 653. 13 i^ =^ =^1 ^- ^ :z^z: The organ-point in Example 654, in which all the Seventh accords common to the stem-tones of a major mode are caused to enter, presents among them the so-called chord-formations already discussed: — 654r. It will be seen, we trust, after this somewhat lengthy discussion, how much simpler the study of Harmony becomes by considering Triads aud Seventh ac- cords, only, as fundamental chord-formations, and all other combinations oi tones either as suspensions of triads, or as organ-points or altered accords, (for the last, see the following chapter). MANUAL OV MUSICAL THEOBT, 233 CHAPTER XXXIII. ALTERED ACCORDS. We have learned thus for the formation and treatment of major, minor, diminished and augmented triads, including suspension-formations in connection with these chords. Reiviakk. — The augmenied triad belongs properly to the catalogue of altered accords, Bince it can never occur without the aid of a chromatic sign, but, as it arises in the milder major and more vigorous minor mode, both of which modes make use of the necessary altered tone, it has acquired in modern times the name and status of a fun- damental harmony. We have, therefore, thought proper to treat of it iu connection with such harmonies, (page 126). Further, we have spoken of all the Seventh accords which can be formed with the stem-tones of a major or minor mode, their entrance, progression and resolution ; also, of suspensions applied to both the entrance and resolution. The ambiguity of the Diminished Seventh accord, its entrance, progression and resolution have also been thoroughly explained. "Remark. — Like' the augmented triad, the Diminished Seventh accord can never oc- cur without the use of a chromatic alteration ; it is therefore, strictly speaking, an altered accord. The artificially-voiced modes referred to in the above remark, contain the Diminished Seventh accord also, which fact, together with the importance of this chord, induced us to present its treatment in a special chapter, (XXXI). The frequent use of the Augmented Sixth-accord, Chord of the Third, Fourth and Augmented Sixth, and Chord of the Fifth and Augmented Sixth, has also gained for them a special name and importance, (Chapter XX). They are all altered accords, however, inas- much as they cannot be produced with the stem-tones alone of any major or minor mode. It is not to be forgotten that by stem-tones, we mean the tones of any mode without the application of accidentals. Finally, in the preceding chapter, we have discussed the so-called, though only seeming, Chords of the Ninth, Eleventh and Thirteenth. We come now to notice that there are still a great number of triads, as well as Seventh accords, which arise through the chromatic elevation or de- pression of any one or more tones of the original or fundamental harmonies. There is no practical advantage gained in giving special names to all of these various combinations, as some theorists have sought to do, therefore we class them under the head of Altered Accords. The most important point is to know from what harmonies they are derived and how they must progress. With the triads in Example 655 we are already famihar ; we recognize them as fundamental harmonies: — Dim: Aug: EBEEdg e».. iE^a=g^i^ 234 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. If we apply ODe or more chromatic alterations to any one of the above tri- ads, thns changing their intervals, an altered accord arises, e. g. ese. 23i= -Kg— nfci :1?^ E ^SJEIgfe^ The effect of many of these altered accords is much improved by being pla- ced in their Third-Sixth or Fourth-Sixth positions, or with the voices dispers- ed ; i. e., in open position. The chord at a, Example 656, may occur in the following-wise : — a. 657. N.B. m ■^i :b^ -iyj It may be asked if the tone B would not be as correct as Clz, in the chord at N.B ? We answer, that the following chord (Bi?, E,G) decides the question, for the tendpncy toward Bb is more clearly defined by writing Cl? than h^. The altered acc^ord (Cb, E, Gr) thereby arises. We have previously remarked that the most natural tendency of a flat, chromatically introduced, is a pro- gression downioard, while that of a i^harp is upward. The progression of a natural, i. e., stem tone in any mode, is neutral, not decisive in either direc- tion; therefore, if a determined progression is desired, it should be as decisive- ly indicated as is consistent under the existing circumstances. In the following examples, instances are given of the manner in which the altered accords at b, c, d, e and/. Example 656, may arise and progress: — h. c. d. At c, Example 658, the middle voice is written G!?, insteail of Y% because of its being afterward led to F, toward which tone F|| does not naturally tend. The lower voice in the same chord is written Cj?, instead of Bk|, becau.se of the MAX^UAL OF MUSICAL THEOEY. 235 desired progression to Bb. As the npper voice can be no other than E, tlio altered accord, Cb, E, Gb, is the result. At d, E^ indicates the progression to Y^ more decisively than FlJ would. Just so G^, in the lower voice, tends toward A, whereas Ab dors not. Tlia C, in the middle voice, is bound, hence the combination, C, VJ^, ii^. At e, tlie progression to A, in the upper voice, is clearly indicated by G|i, wliile in tlie middle voice, the progression chromatically, from E to D is more decidedly felt through E? than Djj:. The lower voice (C) being bound, the combination chances to be C, Eb, G j|. At /, Ebb leads more decisively to Db than would Djj ; Gb, in the middle voice, indicates a progression to F better than Ftt. Remakk. — The accord at/ will be recognized as the Chord of the Augmented Sixth, which, as we here see, is an altered accord. The use of its Fundamental position is seen at /, in the last example of No. 658. That the above altered accords are correctly written will be felt by ever)- cultured musician; but, further, they are all so written as to present recogniza- ble forms to the eye ; i. e., their derivative harmonics are easily detected. We recognize the following as the various kinds of fundamental Seventh accords: — 650. The same as with triads, the application of a chromatic sign to one or more tones of any of the above Seventh accords produces an altered accord, e. g. b. 660 •iai The chord at a, Example 660, could occur in the following-wise: 661. 9' . The resolution or progression of altered Seventh accords is the same as that which is possible to the original chord ; i. e., without alterations. Tiie lead ing of each single voice may often be more limited, so that all the progres- sions of the original accord may not be practicable for the altered accord, but it will be found that the altered accord will have no progressions impossible to the original. To learn what the original chord is, it is only necessary to cancel the a'^ci- dentals in the altered accord foreign to the defined mode. Thus, the original 236 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. chord at N.B., Example 661, would be C, E, G,B, and could progress the same as the altered chord, (see a, Ex. 662). a. b. 663. The progression at 6, although correct for the original accord, would not be practicable for the altered accord in Example 661, for, in the latter, the Gji presses toward A and not toward F. The EjJ! tends toward F^ rather than F|3, which would be only an enharmonic change. Compare a and b in the fol- lowing example: — not : correct : 663. It will be seen, from the above, that what was said about the leading of the voices of the altered accords being more limited than in their original har- monies is verified ; al-so, that the original can make any progression possible to the altered accord. . The only semblance of a rule that can be given for the progression of these chromatically altered tones, is that their natural tendency, degree-whe upward or downward,be observed, provided the voices of the original chord can pro- grens to the same tones. Of course the unaltered tones progress the same as in the original accord. The altered Seventh accord at b, Example 660, might occur in this wise: — 664. b^. ZSl 9^ 321 "Zr- The original of the chord at b, Example 660, would have G^ instead of Oti, but its progression to A would be just as correct though the tendency np ward would not be so clearly felt as it is with Gti. Although only a few of the possible altered accords have been indicatcni in this chapter, yet enough have been given to furnish the student an insight into their character, origin and treatment. They are essentially part and parcel of the music of modern times, but, if naturally introduced and naturally progress- ed, they certainly cannot be regarded as illogical or unjustifiable. Their effect in an organ-point formation is naturally still more striking, but allowable, if all the conditions of such formations are duly observed. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TBEOBY. 237 PART III. ■^^WWWWVw^ SI]Nd:P»LE COXJNTEIlI>OINT. The .four-voiced is unquestionably the purest and fullest, without being over- •oaded, of any harmonic movement ; it has, therefore, been the basis of our studies. However, in most compositions for four-voices, (Quartettes), passa- ges or whole movements occur in which only one, two or three voices are made use of; i.e., as Solo, Duo or Trio, respectively. Again, we find compositions, or parts thereof, in which five, six, seven or eight voices participate, as Quintette, Sextette, Septette or Octette, respective- ly. A greater number than eight voices is rarely used. Although the explanation of the manner of manipulating all these varieties of movement properly belongs to the province of Counterpoint,* it yet seems proper tO us that such rules should be drawn from that department of musical science as will be necessary to show what must be observed in order to write any one of them in an acceptable manner. CHAPTER XXXIV. I. DEVELOPMENT OF MELODY OR PRINCIPAL VOICE. ACCOMPANIMENT FORMS. The first and most important point in the formation of a melody is the selcc' tion of naturally melodic intervals and the avoidance of unnatural, unmelodic. Though often repeated, we enumerate them once more. According to classi- cal rules we reckon as melodic intervals, major and minor seconds, major and minor thirds, minor fourths, major and minor fifths, major and minor sixths, minor sevenths and major octaves, ascending and descending, as follows: — ee The unmelodic intervals are major fourths, (tritone), major sevenths, major and minor ninths : — 666 •M ^ IV vn IX * Weitzman's System of Coanterpoiut and Fugue ia in course of preparation by the Editor oj this work. 238 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Farther, all dimiaished and augmented intervals. la modern or romantic compositions diminished sevenths are regarded as melodic. Of course, when a certain defined effect is sought, then the use of even «/! melodic intervals may be justifiable. In the formation of a melody, or, indeed, any kind of a composition, the composer will most naturally proceed in the same manner as an artist about to reproduce his thoughts upon canvas ; first, an outline and afterward the per- fected work. Supposing a melody to have been outlined, the next procedure is to criticise and improve it with respect to three principal points: — 1. WITH RESPECT TO ITS MELODIC QUALITIES. The melodic element is essentially rfe^rree-wise. The use of skips is not ne- cessarily forbidden, but rather so restricted as not to set aside or injure this es- sential character. Therefore, if the outline contain an over abundance of skips, eliminate them and insert degree-wise progressions in their stead. 2. THE RHYTHM. As has already been remarked, rhythm is one of the most powerful agents at the service of the composer. Through alterations in the rhythm, alone, the dullest, most uninteresting melody may often be given a life and vitality abso- lutely surprising. Therefore, see that the rhythm is interesting, sufiiciently va- ried as to prevent monotony and yet uniform enough to preserve the symme- try. 3. TflE HARMONIC FOUNDATION. A melody should be so ordered as to permit the use of an agreeable variety of harmonies, such as will move freely and flowiiigly among themselves. As a whole, a melody, like a sentence in prose or poetry, should express sense, a definite idea. If words are used, especial care should be taken that they are properly declaimed. Let accented' words and syllables fall on accented .parts of the measure. Observe the inflections, Avhetlier rising or falling, and let the melody move in the same direction. The punctuation is not to be for- gotten. In a word, let the music and words be so wedded together as that both may combine to express the same thoughts and emotions. To make the above comments more lucid we will suppose that a melody first suggests itself to us in the following form or outline: — eer. The first criticism to be made, is, that the melodic element (degree-wise progression) is entirely wanting here. We must correct this, either by the substitution of other notes here and there, the api)lication of appoggiatura^, or by the introduction of passing-notes. We choose the latter metliod, and present in Example 668, an improvement on our outline: — MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 239 ees Moderato. |ie^ q=P ^ -J 1 \—-i ♦H r-- ^^ -P-0 iS •zi 2£: The period has now gained suCBeient melodic flow. SuSicient spring-wise element has been retained to give variety and prevent the monotony which would" just as surely arise in continuous degree-vf'im as in continuous spring- wise progression. The second point of criticism has reference to the rhythm. The continued succession of any one kind of note, as in the above example, certainly has no especial rhythmic interest ; in fact it is decidedly monotonous. The simple in- troduction of a dotted-note will often effect an improvement in this respect, e.g. eeo. The regular recurrence of the dotted-note here in each alternate measure creates at once two-measural rhythm. A still greater alteration in the rhythm of the above melody is seen in the folio wins:: — eyo. In the last example, three varieties of rhythm follow one after the other, (see brackets,!, 2, and 3 ; the fourth measure is like the second), and thereby the melody gains in attractiveness; but, to give so many varieties a significance or symmetry, their repetition is necessary, (see last half or section of the pe- riod). It is well to remark here that the use of too many and too strongly contrasting kinds of rhythm is to be guarded against, otherwise, the connex- ion or unity of the whole will be wanting. It must also not be inferred here that every figure or motive that may appear in the course of a melody or oth- er composition is without exception to be repeated. We are not so hedged in as that, but, as we remarked before, symmetry and unity can be gained only through more or less similar, if not exact, repetition of the motives in question, be it melodic, rhythmic or harmonic. Further, it will be found a matter of decided facilitation, if, in forming a melody, the rhythmic and melodic motives occurring in one section are imita- ted in succeeding sections. It is still more symmetrical if the repetition of a motive take place at the same point in each section, as in the above example. Thus, the motive at 1, beginning the first section, is used again as a beginning to the second section, and so on. In order that the close of a period may take place upon an accented mensural-division, more rhythmic freedom may always be taken, (compare final measures of the two sections). 240 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. By the aid of auxiliary-tones, passing-tones, appoggiatnras, trills, mordents, and formation of passages, a melody may be ornamented and made as florid and brilliant as may be desired, and yet retain the same, or enough of the same melodic and harmonic foundation to enable one to recognize the original. As an example we will apply these various means to the outline of the above melody: — jnz ■^2, — ^ — i — ur— SNish-'-* :?*.-— ^"».^ « "^ i^—- ^— --5-»-# -^— ?= The third point of criticism would be the harmonic foundation; but, as the capabilities of the above melody are so varied in this respect, further comment will be unnecessary, FORMS OF ACCOMPANIMENT. Having spoken of melodic forms, it will be appro'priate to insert here a few remarks concerning the various forms of accompaniment. A few of the most important will sufficiently indicate what is possible. First, so long as the melody moves in and around a single harmony, a sin- gle accord may be sustained. For instance, if a melody moved itself in the Tonic and Dominant harmonies of the mode of F major, the accompaniment eould be as follows: — era. ?B: ^ iiP: ZSl This may be rhythmically changed if more motion is desired, e. g. era. "^^m -:cr -32—1131 -0—0—0 0- II I I I v-w— ^— ^ ■^=^■-'5^ MANUAL OF MUSICAL TELORT. 241 The placing of the voices (a, h, Ex. 674), or the position of the wliole ac- cord may be changed (c), e. g. -0- -m- -^ -«■ -m- -0- -^ -0- -0- -0- G74r. iip^ -z?- ;i ( a — — 0—0 — « — ' ' ' — ■■ — ' '— ' 1 •-- ■ •♦ -#- -•■ -•■ -0--0-0-0-0-0--0--0 ( 1^^=^ The chords may be broken; i. e., aYpeggio form, e. g. 675. iiP: ^1=13 \ vr=^ -^-1- m^^ 675. y 6. 1 ilpE=^^^^ r-?- :2=:f!=5; li^'!^* ^li: jzi : ^rc \S^: i • 0- 6p^E=E^: >-*^ z^/C Eli ^ 242 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. The accord-toues may be elaborated by meaas of auxiliary-tones, appo;:L;ia- turas, passing-notes, etc., e. g. 676. a. ^te ^ # * j - ^ -0 * — - — f^0—-^^<» iipEE c:r=-. -. :*-^ — I ^—d—d S ^-tf-J-P* i 1^* #-»i 1 «~m ' 676. 6. Be :e:i etc. (te*i The voice-leading in all these different forms, is of conrse, to be just as free from faulty progressions as a simple chord-succession. The effect of the par- allel octaves in the following example at o, (see brackets), is just as bad as if written in chords, as at h. a- ^ not: h. 677. -^ m In writing such a succession of harmonies we should very likely lead tho voices as at a, Example 678. The accompaniment would, tiierefore, be devel- oped upon the same basis, (6). MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 243 678. te i^=EE^ -J^ s, < ^ 9^ — I — -J ■ \s 1_= i_si ^-- 1 — 1_ -f^- S 5= i^ ^ Faults, like the following at a, easily arise if attention is not directed to them. Contrary motion is the best preventive. 670. When a suspension occurs in the melody or song, the note of resolution should not appear in the accompaniment (and vice versa) previous to the res- olution of the suspension. This very common fault is a violation of the rule on page 150, (see also Ex's 400 and 401). The usual exceptions, however, prevail, — suspension of the ninth or seventh before the octave of the Bass. CHAPTER XXXY. II. TWO-VOICED MOVEMENTS. All the observations made in connection with the treatment of a single voice are to be repeated here in connection with two voices. The two-voiced move- ment attains its highest development only in a thorough treatise on Counter- point and Fugue. As the present work does not purpose the extended discus- sion of these subjects, therefore, only so much as is absolutely necessary to the comprehension of the plainer phases of a two-part movement (Duett) will be given under the above caption. The various intervals, both consonances and dissonances, are to be entered and progressed exactly as they have been in four-voiced movements, with the exception of the minor fourth. This interval, \ ( fe=i=^ ) standing by it self, lacks fullness and independence, so much so that in writing for two voi- ces it must be treated in the same manner as dissonances. 1. It must arise and progress as a passing-uote, — degree-\;\?,Q^ e. g. 680. it*: 4 y* 244 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. In both of the above examples i\\Q fourth enters and progresses degree-wise the same as a dissonance. The following example, (681), however, would not be correct either in the entrance or in the progression of the fourth, because both are effected spn'ng'-wise, e. g. not. I ! 681.^^g It should be remarked here that in cases where the two voices move in such a manner as to represent (see remarks on this point, page 16,) a Third-Sixth, or Fourth-Sixth accord, then t\i% fourth would be treated the same as in three, and four-voiced movements, e. g. 682, i 'J21 r :i is: is: I 4 ' I 14 11 2 The minor fourth may appear in the character of a bound dissonance, bound above or below. Then, of course, all the rules relative to preparation, attack and resolution, as given on pages 146-59, are to be strictly observed, e.g. ess. ^^^ r .■T*- „ rrr 51= VARIETIES OF MOTION. These are the same as given on pages 74--t5. Contrary motion best asserts the independence of the voices while Parallel best expresses their .union. The beginning and end must indicate the Tonic-triad. Thecloseis most fre- quently made with a doubled prime I Vfrv A I or Tonic and its octave The Tonic and third, third and Tonic, and Tonic and fifth, form just as cor- rect but not so firm endings. Fifth and Octave progressions. Not on\j parallel but also covered oc- taves and fifths are forbidden in two-voiced movements, e. g. 084:. 2t^ The effect of the above covered fifth and octave, in two-voiced movements, is but very little better than that of the following parallels, therefore, theii exclusioa: — ess. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 245 In two-voiced movements, note against note may be used, or two notes a- gaiust one, three notes against one, etc. NOTE AGAINST NOTE. In the first species the following is to be observed: — 1. CoriHonances only are to be used, (the minor fourth in a Counter^Doint of two voices, is to be regarded as a dissonance). They may enter sjjring-wise or degree-wise and progress in the same manner. In modern compositions, however, the dissonances which enter free in four- voiced writing are also allowed to enter free in two-voiced movements; thus, with two voices we may represent the Diminished triad. Dominant and Dimin- ished Seventh accords in all their positions. 2. Consonant fifths and octaves should be frequently alternated with thirds and sixths, which latter are fuller intervals. 3. As the accented measural-divisions stand outmost prominently, too many consonant fifths and octaves placed upon these accents will cause the whole movement to lack fullness. 4. Too many parallel thirds or sixths cause a lack of independence. 5. Parallel major thirds are not often good: — 6. Where one voice springs, cause the other, where practicable, to pro- gress degree-wise. \ 7. Avoid all cross-relations -( ^ 1^ 8. In the way of cadence-formations we present the following:- 68G. ^i-^- ISI N.B. K.B. The diminished triad is often used in cadences, in free style, (X.B). For practice, it is recommended that a cant us fir mus be composed orselect- ed, and the second voice or counterpoint set thereto, first as lower and then as upper voice. We choose for our illustrations, the following c.f. 68 '•ill ? — I — To this we apply a counterpoint according to the above observations: — Cantiis firmus. /T\ ess. < -52- (m^ Counter-point. 246 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TIIEOET. Example 689, presents the c.f. as lower voice, to which a counterpoint, {c.p.) as upper voice is added: — c.p. 680. In minor, the close should be preceded by the leading-tone which is always chromatically altered, e. g. 690. Referrmg to what was said about placing too many consonant fifths and oc- taves upon the accented measural-divisions, it will* be seen that the following example, at a, lacks fullness on that account. The example at b, makes use of the full-sounding consonances on the accented, throwing the others upon tlie unaccented parts: — better : 601. TWO NOTES AGAINST ONE. In this species of coimterpoint, the primary accent or beginning of the measure is to be consonant, while the note which follows may be consonant (a, Ex. 692) or it may be a regular passing-note; i.e., a note coming degree- wise from, and progressing degree-wise into a consonance (6x). 603. =^- JZL 13: Neither ^//i.s nor octaves are to be placed upon consecutive accejits, for the prominence thereby given them produces the effect of parallel fifths and oc- taves, The unaccented notes, lying between, do not hinder tliis effect, e.g. 603/ ^ ^ MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 247 If the notes forming the fifths or octaves occur unaccented, the bad effect will be for the greater part removed, e. g. 694. 9==^- 1^+- Making use of the same c.f. as at first, we add a couuterpuiiit of two nut: s against one, according to the above rules and observations, first us lower, (G95) and then as upper voice, (696). e©5. When a rest occurs, the first note thereafter is to be consonant. c.p 696. c.f. ip 131 i In a counterpoint of three notes against one the same rule for the primary accent prevails. Of the second and third notes, one or both may be conso- nant, or they may be regular passing-notes. FOUR NOTES AGAINST ONE. As before, the primary accent should be consonant. Once for all, this is the classical rule, and one that is always safe to abide by. Modern composers, however, sometimes deviate from this rule, in the freer style, by using a pass- ing-note or an appoggiatura upon the primary accent. This is justifiable, of course, if a compensatory advantage is thereby gained, such as a better lead- ing of the voices, or in order to avoid a false progression. In the present species, there is also an accent upon the third measural-divis- ion, ( I* I* ^ I* ) therefore, if the counterpoint is to be perfectly pure and trans- parent, both of these accents should receive consonances. If it is desired, however, the second accent as well as the usual unaccented measural-di visions may be given passing-notes, even according to classical rules. 1^0. 697, will serve as an example in which the above observations are heed- ed:— 248 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. eoy. f^ =^-_ c.f. cp. 91^^ ft-0 r^fi. -.\± ftp &4= The c.f. may be employed as the lower voice and a counterpoint as upper voice added thereto. SIX NOTES AGAINST ONE. In this species, the accents are of two kinds. If written in | time there are two accents: — r£ * * ' * M* T If ii^ I ti^e there are three: — ^ A f 4- r r r r i-^' i . The passage will. naturally be purer if each accent re- ceives a consonant, but it is only necessary that the primary accent be so EIGHT NOTES AGAINST ONE. The accents in this variety are as follows: — e»00»0»0 The pri- mary accent is to be consonant, and, generally, the secondary (fifth measural-di- vision) also, though this is not obligatory. The lesser accents are also option- ally consonant. In this connection we will explain at length a means of fa- cilitating the application of a counterpoint or second voice to a given c.f.., viz: the c.f. having been written, the whole phrase or period is to be surveyed and the harmonies determined which may naturally succeed each other upon such a melody. Thelv fundamentals are to be recorded in the same manner as set forth in the chapter upon Harmonic Accompaniment, (XXII), e. g. G9S. F :3: Even two voices can present the outline of a harmony; therefore, the above process will direct the attention to the harmonic foundation also, and thereby add interest to the whole passage. Having fixed upon the harmonies it will bo found easy and very advantageous to write down the first note in each measure of the conntf^vpoint, e. g. I F C F'C G D CF eoo. te aii c.f. 2lfe=Z= :^ MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT: 249 The chief points having been determined, the only thing remaining is to fill out the spaces in this outlined counterpoint. These are to be filled out as me- lodically as possible, avoiding both parallel and covered octaves and fifths. In a plirase where so many notes in one part appear against one of another part, it is imperative t.o determine beforehand what note the counterpoint must reach in order to be consonant with the corresponding note in the c.f. Thus, in the above example the goals, so to speak, having been determined, a c.p. commencing at one note or goal, is to be so ordered and lengthened as to move smoothly to the next, thereby melodically connecting these two points. For example, using the beginning of the above sketch, the cp. might move as follows : — yoo. The following additional facilite will often be found useful in simplifying the process of adding these intermediate notes. The application of four notes a- gainst one is certainly much easier than eight against one, therefore if the whole note in Example 700, be divided, or imagined as divided, into half-notes the process will be virtually four notes against one. We should then have two goals to each measure, and the distances being short, the counterDoint can be filled out with corresponding ease, e. g. 701. Pursuing the plan just indicated, we present the entire cantiisfirmus with the completed counterpoint, e. g. yoa. 250 MANUAL OF MVSIGAL THEOBT. At N.B., a minor fourth occurs npon the secondary accent; its treatment as a passing-note will be noticed. It is self-understood that the division of the whole into half-notes here is only temporarily done, therefore, the appearance of the exercise properly written will be as follows: — ■5^03. :s:: I 9 — fi-ff- ©^p^EfeS^fe «E S±?EiES 3?: The farther varieties, with twelve or sixteen notes against one, have the Bame rules as those already given. SUSPENSIONS. BOUND DISSONANCES. BOUND CONSONANCES. SYNCOPES. The Bound Dissonance is especially characteristic of the contrapuntal style of composition. The Bound Consonance is also important, but occupies a sec- ond place, when compared with th.e first named. The rules for suspensions . have been comprehensively noticed on pages 146-59. The same are to be ob- served here. In a bound consonance no resolution, as such, is necessary; its progression may be degree-wise upward or downward, or spring-wise to any other consonance. CANTUS FIEMUS AS UPPER VOICE. SUSPENSIONS FROM BELOW. To pi'actically illustrate the application of suspensions in two voices, let ns take the following c/., first as upper voice: — ^«^-§= The preparation, which will take place in the first measure, can be effected by means of each tone in the mode of C major which forms a consonance with the tone C. The consonant tones below C, are C, A, V and E, hence, each oi these will in turn be used in the following examples as preparation-notes. First, binding C as the preparation-note, it becomes dissonant through the en trance of D ia the c.f. and then resolves downward to B, e. g. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. 251 ros. s In Example 706, the consonaut A is used as the preparation, and, by t\\o entrance of the D, a minor fourth arises. This must be resolved downward the same as a dissonance. The resolution to a fifth lacks fullness, to be sure, but as the same suspension is valuable in movements for three or more voices, we ffive it here: — C. /-(S>- yoGJ -4 .(2. 5 -^ ?5 The tone F is used in the following suspension as the preparation-note. The entrance of the D yields a consonance, therefore, the progression of the F may be degree-wise downward, (a) using E as a passing-note to a further pro- gression, or it may spring to any other consonance, (6). (The progression here of the F a degree upward, to G, would yield parallel fifths). ii ^or. m -s>- m fe Example 108, shows the attempted use of E as a preparation-note. Through the entrance of D the bound tone becomes dissonant and ought therefore to resolve a degree downward, to D. According to an already given principle, (viz: a tone which has been heard icifh the dissonance cannot be used immediately afterward as the resolution of that dissonance), this resolution cannot take place. The suspension is, therefore, null and void and never to be used either in two, three or more voices : — not : -, yos, 9— ^ The Bass alone has the inherent power to sustain a suspension before its own tone. This exception is the Suspension of the Ninth, (see Ex. 110), and Suspension of the Seventh, already shown. CANTUS FIRMUS AS LO"SVER VOICE. SUSPENSIONS FROM ABOVE. If we use the above c.f as the lower voice, the consonant tones above, which may be used as preparation-notes, are C, E, G and A. 252 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. First, C as a preparation-note, and, as in * time there is an accent upon the third measural-division also, ( • f * • ) the dissonance may be attacked at that point The example at a, 109, is .usually written as at &, e. g. TOO p r -i- ^ h. ^ J. r- '-^ In the following example, the ninth is suspended before the octave; the Suspension of the Ninth just alluded to. It must always be approached in contrary or obliqne motion, or else the effect of parallel or covered octaves will be distinctly heard: — ■710. 9 8 ^ -<9~Kr j L'.g— j-^ — '- Z^L -f9--- I A nu^.'penHion never removes the eff'ect of a faulty progression. Similar to the Suspension of the Ninth, that of the sixth before the fffh, and the /owr//i before the Jifth must always be approached in oblique or con- trary motion, in order to avoid consecutive fifths, e. g. not ; not : yii. m — 1- 6 5 -27- m^^ iE ^.^ 5 5 4 5 , — f^ -^ ^-1!^^:^ Using Gr as a preparation note, and the same c.f. as lower voice, a minor fourth arises. Its treatment is the same as a dissonance, — it is resolved a de- gree downward, e. g. ^ I ' I -yp ; yi3 m. crrr^- In using A as a preparation, no dissonance results ; the progression of the bound tone is consequently not determined, e. g UJ 4—, MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 253 For the pupils exercise in this direction, any one or more of the various other melodic intervals may be taken as the c.f. and used first as upper and then as lower voice or vice verm. All the tones in the same mode which are consonant with the first note of each c.f. given below, are to be used as pre- paration-notes, then bound, and, through the entrance of the second note of the c.f., the result will be either a dissonance or consonance which is to be re- solved or progressed in the manner we have indicated in the preceding exam- ples: — t 1 714= in VI I V The major fourth and major seventh are omitted because of .their being un- raelodic intervals. The foregoing suspensions have all been effected according to classic rules. In modern compositions the dissonances which are allowed to euttr free are also allowed to be used as preparations to suspensions. These are the minor fifth, minor and diminished seventh. The reason of this license is found in the mildness of their dissonance, e. g. ^^^•^^^ i^- 6* — »- -»- 4 3 =I5?Z=t5 «_l ■Z?-7 -€/- ,, The following examples will suggest in what manner suspensions may be em- ployed upon a more extended c.f. 71 e. ^^ ^ m c.f. c. p. iip3 d=r S_X5.^ riy. 254 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEOBT. CHAPTER XXXVL III. THREE-VOICED MOVEMENTS. With the aid of three voices we are able to present a complete triad, and also the principal voices {fundamental, third and seventh) of a Seventh ac- cord. Through the leading of the voices certain tones in these chords will be often omitted and other tones doubled in their stead. In a Tliird-Fifth accord (the Fundamental position of a triad) the Jifth may be omitted and therefor iho, fundamental or third doubled, e. g. 718, In former times, the third was often omitted and the fundamental or fifth doubled, especially at the beginning and end of a period or composition, e. g. yiQ, Their use in this way has become obsolete, except, perhaps, where this very lack of fullness expresses the precise character desired. In a, Third-Sixth accord, the third may be omitted and either of the other tones doubled in its stead, e. g. rao. - — 1&- 6 6 A Fourth-Sixth accord, in which no tone can be omitted without changing the chord, is to be treated as a bound dissonance or as a passing-chord. As a bound dissonance, the fourth or both fourth and sixth may be bound and resolved a degree downward, e. g. 731. n 1 1 V --■^ ^ -IX-i _J 3 JL <^ ^ S 1 rm ■a 1 V J ^ 6 4 3 r 6 4 1 5 3 C\» ^ - 1 1 /O 1 As we already know, the entrance and progression of a consonant Third- Sixth accord is entirely free; hence, the minor fourth, when appearing as a part of this accord, will progress in the same way, e. g. 730. /ft— Fifths and octaves are not to be allowed even upon consecutive accents, e. g. rso. 9— -^ y^ ->9--'^\J MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 257 If fifths or octaves occur upon unaccented parts of the measure, wliile oth- er intervals appear upou the between-lying accents, tlieir judicious use may be permitted, e. g. 731. The principal cadences with three voices ^I'e as follows: — 733 In the following exercises, in writing for three voices, the same plan will be pursued as that adopted for the two-voiced movement, viz: note against note, two notes against one, etc. The most practical way of working out a three- voiced movement is as follows: — Having composed or selected the c.f., first outline a counterpoint and afterward add the third or filling-voice, at which time such alterations may be made, if found necessary, as shall adapt these applied voices to the c.f., remembering, however, that each voice, when sepor rately regarded, is to be as melodic as possible, and that the three voices when united shall present an intelligible harmonic succession. We shall make use of the same c.f. as in Example 687, and first set NOTE AGAINST NOTE. In this species we are to use only consonant. intervals, consonant triads and the dissonant intervals and accords which are allowed to enter free. Follow- ing the above suggestion, we first apply a counterpoint, e. g. 733. te c.f. c.p. ip= zsn 1^ To this c.f. as Soprano, and c.p. as Bass, we are to next add \\\q filling-voice. This may be either Tenor or Alto. The following point is to he borne in mind in the addition of this third voice, viz: such tones are to be employed as will increase the harmonic effect as much as possible and yet not sacrifice tlie for- 258 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORT. mation of an independent melody. Observing this, Example 133, three-voiced, aaay take upon itself the following treatment: — ra^. E la: ^ Filling-voiee. ^. Upon examination it will be seen that each voice in Example 734 is of itself an independent melody, and that unitedly they form acceptable harmonies. The exercise should be varied by using the c.f. as Bass and applying there- to a c.p. as upper voice, adding afterward a third or filling-voice, (/. u.), e. g. c. p. 735. 3z: ^ r-iS'<5>- J^- :p=s =pzg--zi 3 c./. A still further variation is to be gained by using the c.f. as a middle voice. In this case it , is quite immaterial which of the outer voices be first added. Whichever it may be, of course that voice will be ttie c.p., and the last added will be the/.'U. It is not necessary that the counterpoint in a three-voiced phrase be applied exactly as in one of two voices. This remark applies espe- cially to the minor fourth and to covered octaves and fftha, the first of which is treated like a dissonance, and the last of which are eutirely excluded in two- voiced movements. For example, suppose we apply to the sauie c.f. the fol- lowing c.p.i — 736. At N.B , minor fourths are used like consonances, which in two-voiced move- ments is not permitted. If now, in adding the third voice, care is taken to form Third-Sixth accords at these points, the fourths will be correctly used ac- cording to the rules for three-voiced phrases, e. g. ray. n ^' ^' ITS /fc^n ■ (5 —/S' 9 _^- \ i <» ^ "^ 6 -^ 1 6 r7\ 9-rf5" — tSf -■ — f5> 1 -^ q ^ 'rXTj ^j f^J 1 V 1 The middle or filling-voices may now be supplied, remembering that each one is to present as melodic a form as is consistent with the harmonic whole, e. g. ■767. F E® F C B[, F c F IJ 1 1 fLhi^ ^_ /^ o ^ r ^ % 5 r3 \ -<5«- " r^ "^ ■^ -^ -^ /TV C\' <^ % '^ }• , i^ ^ \X-, in in V The c.f. should in turn be placed in the other voices, and the remaining three parts applied thereto, note against note. We present one more example in this species, in which the c.f. appears in the lowest voice, leaving the student to work out similar examples with the c.f. in the Alto or Tenor. In Exam- ple 168, the Soprano vv'ould be the first voice added, and afterward the Alto and Tenor. The outer voices, on account of their prominence, should receive the advantage of the first attention. The key of C is here used on account of the better position of the voices, e. a. ■768. J3~ — <>' 2E isi: ^ «./• 268 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. TWO NOTES AGAINST ONE. In this species, out of the recognized chord-formations is to be used upon the primary accent. The second or unaccented measural-division may be con- sonant; i.e., an accord-tone of the preceding harmony, or it may be a regular passhig-note. Great care must be taken or the progression of this after-note with some other voice or voices to the next chord will be faulty, (parallel oc- taves, fifths, etc). For the greater part, Example 769, contains this elaboration in the lowest voice. It also appears, occasionally, in the middle-voices either to avoid faults or to o-ain such harmonic? as will better connect the accented accords, (N.B., 1 and 2.) C.f. /T\ 760. ZSISI ^^^E^^l=i^if^^ c. p. As usual, the c.f. should be placed in each voice in turn, and each of the other voices elaborated in the same manner as the Bass in the above example. In this and following species, the c.f. having been written down, the elabora- ted voice is the next to be outlined and the filling-voices afterward added. THREE NOTES AGAINST ONE. The same rule prevails respecting the primary accent, while one or both of the other notes may be accord-tones or passing-notes. In this example (770) we place the c.f. in the Tenor, and the elaboration in the upper, and occasion- ally in the other voices: — 770. The rules for four, six and eight, or more notes against one, are the same as those already given. Each species should be worked out with the c.f., and a figuratcd voice in each part alternately. Then, attempts may be made in the imitative style, or*in the simultaneous figuration of two or more voices, as for example in the following, in which are set SIX NOTES AGAINST ONE. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. 269 vvx.. 1 1 fe #-v^ W-=^ ^-0 ^—^ «^ ■iS'-T- ■s>-^- i^-^-'j sr± — *—sr— -f=^ T \ r __ r_ ^fe^ J J - ■ i-J — !— i^-J--! — ^ — \ — I — ^ , — ^ — u^- f-r ■ SUSPENSIONS IN FOUR-VOIGED MOVEMENTS. Exercises in suspensions should here follow upon the same cantus firmi as given in the table, (page 253); further, the same systematic development is to be pursued as in three-voiced movements, only the field is still wider here on account of the additional voice. Thus, the c.f. may appear in each voice in turn, and the suspensions alternately in the other three voices; and, further, each voice may use all the different consonances of the first note of the c.f. as preparation-notes. In the following specimens we shall present the c.f. in each voice and only one suspension in each of the other parts, leaving the pupil to make use of the remaining consonances. First, an example with the c,f. in the Soprano and suspensions in the Bass^ Tenor and Alto: — c.f. 773. 321 gz; ti y- iS> - ^> ^^• 9? :??= A I -^ '-^ The consonance C is used as the preparation-note in each of the above ex- amples in order to show the different relative positions of the remaining voices thereto. The other consonances to be used here, as preparation-notes, are F and A, (E cannot be used in this capacity, with this c.f. in any of the upper voices, because its resolution could not be proj^erly effected). Example 773, employs the c.f. as Bass, with suspensions in the other voices, using the consonance E as a preparation-note. Here arise Suspensions of the Ninth. The two voices forming such suspensions must always approach the suspension in contrary motion, in order to avoid parallel octaves. The other consonances to be used here, as preparation-notes, are C, G and A. 2Y0 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. yra. ::sz: t:^ 3?: r:^ ir;^zs: ii ::2i ::^ c. /. ' Placing the c.f. in the Tenor or Alto, suspensions may be formed above and below upon each consonance except E. The consonances above the c.f. are C, G and A, and those heloxi^ are C, F and A. For example, the e. /. in the Tenor: — (tonsonn'M^.) 77^ c. f. in the Alto and suspensions above and below :- yys. Having thoroughly comprehended the preparatory exercises in the art of suspensions in four-voiced movements, their application to a more lengthy c.f. should follow, e. g. 7 ye. At N.B., is a reminder that the bound tone can spring to any and every accord-tone previous to its regular resolution, (see remarks and examples on this point, page 151). MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT 271 CHAPTER XXXYIII. V. MOVEMENTS FOR MORE THAN FOUR VOICES. It will not be necessary to develop the five, — six, — seven, — or eight-voiced movement so thoroughly as we have the two, — three, — and four-voiced. Those who have an inclination, or the occasion therefor, will have little difficulty in its accomplishment, when, in addition to the preceding, the following suggestions are also observed. In movements for more than four voices no accord can appear without one or more of its tones being doubled or tripled, and this necessity for duplication naturally increases with every voice additional. To illustrate the treatment of these added parts, we shall make use of the various chord-successions presented in the Harmony System, beginning with the succession of triads in which i\\Q fundamental falls a third. Two essential principles are here, as everywhere, to be italicized, viz: 1. Parallel unisons or octaves are to be used in a composition for two, threet four, or more voices, only when they are intended to form a purely melodic phrase. In pure harmonic structure, however, parallel unisons, octaves and ffihs, are to be strictly excluded. 2. No tone which has a certain determined- progression is to be doubled. This excludes the doubling of sevenths, bound dissonances, and the leading- tone, as such. Covered octaves and fifths may be given much more liberty than has been allowed in fom'-voiced movements. The greater fullness of the chords con- ceals proportionally the lack of purity in the voice-leading. In a triad-succession, four-voiced, where the fundamental falls a third, the voice-leading, as we know, would be as follows: — vrr. In order to add new voices, without creating faults, it can take place: I., Through doubling the connecting-tones, ad libitum, e. g. ■778. 272 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEORT. It is deemed unnecessary to give separate examples of the manner in which the above and following chord-successions would appear, five, sLx, and seven- voiced, etc., the purpose here, being to give an idea how many voices can be used and how they are to be treated, leaving the number to be selected from this mass to individual occasion. It is suggested, however, that for the sake of practice, at least a part of the exercises in triad-successions, (pages 18-98), be worked out five-voiced, etc., the same as they were with four voices. To better manifest the independence of the voices : II, Those tones which can remain stationary may he interchanged. In the above succession, C and E are stationary tones, therefore, instead of binding them, C may progress to E, and E to C, e. g. yyo. The covered fifths or octaves which result from this manner of treatment, as well as in general, in many-voiced movements, are not to be heeded, especially if they appear in the inner voices. III. Voices whose progression is not limited can spring to any tone of the new accord, provided parallel octaves or fifths do not thereby arise, e.g. ^ h. r?:' ^•^ yso. ^ 1 n-— —^ /^ rj - \ -»-'^:z^-6f>- At a, Example 180, three voices, starting from C, spring to three different tones, (A,C, E, all the tones of the new accord), while a fourth voice remains stationary. It, of course, rarely occurs that four voices would appear in uni- son, but the above example not only hints at what could be done in such a case, but also shows what a number of progressions a single voice, occurring in the same position, might have to choose from. At h, of the same example, the G progresses to every tone of the new ac- cord, (A, C, E), but as it is not capable of being used as a connecting-tone, like the C, (at at), its manipulation is a trifle less varied. We see here that the progressing tones in a chord-succession may also be reduplicated and move in various directions, provided the progressions of those tones are not limited as is the case with the seventh, leading-tone, and bound dissonances. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 273 The same things are to be observed in many-voiced triad-successions where the fundaviental rises a third. An example or two will be sufficient: — a. . h. 781.. m ^ S> - At a, Example tSl, is given the simple four-voiced succession; at 6, the sta- tionary tones, only, are doubled; at c, two voices interchange; at d, are shown some of the various progressions starting from a single tone. In the next triad-succession \k\Q fundaraenlal was caused to fall a fifth. This yielded but one connecting or stationary tone, the leading of the other voices being as follows: — rs3. This stationary tone can be re-duplicated at will: — telslE^ ■n9-' --l9- 7*83. According to the method of treatment explained in connection with Exam- ple 780, those tones which can remain stationary, as well as those which must move, may be reduplicated and led in various ways, care being taken to avoid unmelodic progressions, open octaves and fifths. In the application of this treatment to the chord-succession before us, the following will serve as au il- lustration: — 784. ^>'" 274 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. The same conditions prevail and the same manipulation as the above is to be employed when the fundamental rises a fifth, e. g. 785. ^ ^ ^ >5> 1 S> - r ^y 1 «5'^^^-5? ' iS^ ^mmm O TSi;^'^ 1 In triad-successions, where no connecting-tones exist, still more care is ne- cessary in the leading of the voices, as we have already learned. As in such successions, many-voiced, every tone must move to a new place, so every re- duplication must be progressed in a different manner from all other reduplica- tions of the same tone. This can be done by leading these voices in contrary motion, or by progressing each one of them to different accord-tones, e. g. 786. < ^ P^^E^ ^ ^g^^^^^ The outer voices in chords not connected should be especially well led. Con- trary motion is best adapted thereto. Seventh accords, many-voiced, are to be treated exactly as if four-voiced. The original seventh, having a limited progression, can never be doubled. Kemaek — Isolated cases occur wliere a melodic leading of two voices in oblique or contrary motion causes the temporarj' duplication of the seventh, but in the pure har- monic structure the genuine doubling of this member as an accord-ione, never occurs, since both voices would be obliged to resolve the same way, thereby producing paral- lel octaves or unisons. Every other voice of a Seventh accord but the original seventh, may be re- duplicated and led in the same way as the various parts of a triad, e. g. 787. MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. 275 Diminished Seveath accords are to be avoided in many-voiced phrases, be- cause reduplication of its voices generally yields bad-sounding covered octaves or fifths. Having spoken of the purely harmonic treatment of polyphonic successions, a few words will follow here concerning the figurated phase of the same. IV. Each voice may be figurated through some one or more of the follow- ing mediums: — accord-tones, passing-notes, auxiliary-tones, or appoggiaturas ; i. e., one or more voices may use the accord-tones in arpeggio form while the remaining voices sustain their respective tones {a, Ex. 788), or the spaces be- tween these accord-tones may be filled out with passing-notes, (6). Further, the contiguous or auxiliary-tones may be used especially well in ornamenting a stationary tone (c) ; and, lastly, accord-tones or even passing-tones may be or- namented by means of appoggiaturas or free dissonances, (d). rss. i m -#-#- 321 Even more care is necessary in the above figurative treatment, in order to avoid faulty progressions, than in the chord-successions, and, where tue figura- tion is to be applied simultaneously to two or more voices, the call i/> caution is still more imperative. 276 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. PART IV. r-fM^)/\/\r^-^ CHAPTER XXXIX. SY":^OPSIS OF OOMI^OSITIOISr FOIl^VIS. It is the purpose of the present section to emimerate, in a brief manner, the various forms of composition and the fundamental principles to be observed in their construction. The simplest, most ordinary and most symmetrically sustained is the SONG FORM. It may be used for one, two, three or more voices, and usually contains two parts, called unitedly a Period, and respectively a Thesis and Antithesis. These latter are, in turn, sub-divided into sections of two or more measures, as for example, in the following scheme: — A n tithesU. Section. •789. 1 1 J J 1 Period, A Period, in this Form, often contains three parts, called Thesis, Middle Phrase and Antithesis. The number of measures in each part is indefinite, but an important rule is, that the Middle Phrase shall not be longer than the Thesis, as the symmetrical relation would otherwise be disturbed. The An- tithesis may be longer, but never shorter than the Thesis. TOO. i^^^^ The Thesis and Antithesis will naturally revolve themselves, for tlie greater part, in the principal Key, and the Middle Phrase will oftenest appear in a re- lated Key. Toward the end of the Thesis, a modulation may be made to the Key to be used in the Middle Phrase, and again, near tne end of the Middle Phrase, a modulation may be made, leading back to the principal Key, which will be used ai>;ain in the Antithesis. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 277 SONG WITH ACCOMPANIMENT. Prior to everything else, the accompaniment is to be the very counterpart of the character of both song and words. ' Its form is naturally the same as the song, but, iu addition, it usually has a Prelude aud Postlude, and, often. Interludes. The Prelude, which should not be too long, — generally two or four measures is sufficient, — is designed to in- troduce the peculiar character, or tone-colom-, of the song itself. To this end, it may use the principal melody, or a motive therefrom, or quite another mo- tive, but of the same character. It may, also, consist of a characteristic ac- companiment form. It is usual to begin the prelude with the principal key, and close it with the Dominant accord, thereby allowing the song to begin in the principal key a- gain. The interlude or passage while the song pauses, and the postlude or coda, are not to employ, as a general thing, new motives. The unity of the whole is not to be disturbed unless a deviation is necessary in order to follow up the character of the song. DANCE FORM. A period in this form ordinarily comprises two parts, (Thesis and Antithe- sis), both of which may be repeated, and the rhythm is usually quite symmet- rically sustained. The second part may be longer than the first, but never shorter. In regard to the viodidation, the opening meixsures should establish the principal key througli use of the harmonies found in some one of the well-known cadences. The first part may close in this principal key, in which case, the second part will at once commence in the related key, which has been determined for it, finally closing in the principal key, (that used by the first part). It is still more interesting, if, iu the first part, the principal key having been established, a modulation is made closing in the key (often the Dominant) which is to be used by the second part. In this case, part second can touch more remote keys in its modulations, but must, of course, close in the princi- pal key. The Dance Form, usually, has a middle phrase called a Trio. This is sometimes designated in the composition and sometimes not. I t appears in a ke^M^lated to the principal one, that of the Dominant or one related in the JJlird/ancl has the same fornTas the priuei]);!! phrase. It may be as long but not longer than the principal phrase. This latter is of primary consideration, while the trio is secondary. This middle phrase should be in the general char- acter of the principal phrase, yet ofier interesting rhythmic aud modulatory contrasts. The principal phrase is generally repeated aftir the ti'io; aud, when these two do not stand in smooth melodic and harmonic relation to each other, a short, modulatory interlude may be inserted connecting them. The same key is veiy^seldom used for the principal phrase and trio also ; and 278 MAirUAIi OF MUSICAL THEOBT. the trio should not ordinarily appear in the .kex.of^e_Sub:domiBant, as often happens in the compositions of novices. This is rarely to be found in the works of acknowledged masters, and in these isolated instances, a sufficient reason is generally apparent. Further, in most such cases a short modulation follows the trio in which the Dominant of the principal key is heard, thus re- instating that principal key, (see, for example, the modulation after the trio, in the Scherzo in Beethoven's Alz Sonata, Op. 26). If one phrase appear in C major, for example, and another in the key of its Sub-dominant, (F major), it is not difficult to mistake which is the principal key. If now, the key of the Dominant ( G major) is heard, we are not at a loss to discover that C major is the principal, and these others the auxilliary modes. The composition may end with the repetition of the principal phrase, or a coda may still follow, in which the character of the whole piece is to be inten- sified, or which shall lead more smoothly to the final repose. The coda should not exceed the length of the principal phrase. The important points in com- positions of this class are melodic and rhythmic effects. SCHERZO. The character of the Scherzo is, in general, bright and joyful. Its form and changes of key can be exactly the same as those of the above-explained Dance Form, but its treatment, or development, is to be more artistic; i.e., more attention is to be given to the manipulation of motives. The first part (Thesis) of the principal phrase generally makes use of one or two, seldom more, motives; and the second part (Antithesis) rarely adds a new motive, but is rather to treat in freest style those given out in the Thesis. The trio has two parts, a Thesis and Antithesis, both of which are to be treated in a similar manner, and which unitedly are to present a melodic, rhythmic and modulatory contrast to the principal period. This contrast may be gained by means of the treatment of dotted-notes, accompaniment forms, figurations in the various voices, etc., (see scherzi, of Beethoven). After the trio, the Ba Capo follows. It is often written out, in which case it is generally sought to intensify the character of the whole through effective rhythmic, melodic or harmonic alterations. THE ANDANTE, ADAGIO, AND LARGHETTO, have also the same form as the Scherzo, but differ in character, inasmuch as they are more earnestly sustained. The Scherzo and Andante, etc., frequently enter into the construction of the Sonata, which will now be briefly described. THE SONATA, as well as the instrumental Duo, Trio, Quartette, etc., Symphony and Con- certo, are compositions upon a broader base, being constructed of several parts or pieces of music, all of which unite in the expression of some one defined idea or character. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 279 The succession of these parts, or Movements, as we shall designate them, is generally as follows:— I. Firat movement; generally in a lively temj)o, Allegro for example. An introduction may precede the first movement proper. II. Second movement; in a slower tonpo, Andante, etc. III. Third movement; Scherzo, (used formerly in Minuett style, a digni- fied dance). (The order of II. and III. may be reversed if desired). lY. Finale, or Rondo. Sometimes other parts, not mentioned here, are inserted. For example, variations between II. and III., or another Andante or ^c/agrio, etc., between III. and IV., etc. On the other hand, Sonatas frequently contain only one movement, (I.), or two, (I. and IV.), or three, (I., II. and IV). The Concerto appears oftenest in the last-named order, (I., II. and IV.), and while it expresses a defined character, like all compositions of worth, the artistic skill of the virtuoso is also to be given full opportunity for display; brilliant passages and characteristic effects of the peculiar instrument to be employed are not to be forgotten. In the j^rs^ movement (I.) of a Sonata, or similar composition, a clearly de- fined disposition or frame of mind is to be as clearly enunciated, — tranquil or agitated, joyful or sorrowful, etc. Hence the names often applied: — Sonata Pathetique, Sonata Appassionata, Symphony Pastorale, Symphony Eroica, Concerto 3Iiiitaire, etc. In the Scherzo (II.) or a Minuett of livelier tempo, the character expressed in the first movement is to be taken up, and its favorable characteristics pre- sented in as bright and joyous a manner as possible. In the Andante, Adagio or Larghetto (III.) following, the exact opposite of the Scherzo is to be given out; i. e., the character expressed in the first move- mentj (I.) is to be as earnestly sustained as possible. In the last movement (IV., Finale or Rondo,) the result or^ conclusion of these various phrases is to be proclaimed. Either it is to be brighter and more joyous than all, or more depressed or sorrowful, — in a word, it is to be the in- tensified expression of the predominating character in the several preceding movements precipitated into one. This much as a synopsis of the esthetical phase of the Sonata, from which we now turn to give a brief outhue of its technique or order and plan of development. FIRST MOVEMENT. This is divided into two parts, a Thesis and Antithesis, each of which are sub-divided into a Principal, Middle and Closing Phrase or Theme, to which last a Coda is added. PART 1. (THESIS. ) The Principal Theme, or a simple motive, is to begin the composition in the principal key to be used. This suggestion is always safe to abide by. The 280 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TEEOBT. key should be clearly defined before the introduction of foreign harmonies The principal tlieme having been given out, a connective passage or inter- lude is to follow, formed of motives in the preceding theme, or of new ones^ at will, modulating to a key related to that used in the principal theme, in which related key a second or Middle Theme is to be given out. This new theme is to offer a contrast to its predecessor in the way of rhyth- mic alterations as well as in the change of mode; i.e., it is to present either an agitated, or else a 'more subdued, voicing of the character exf)ressed in the first theme. Notwithstanding the contrast, a consistent relation should always be traceable, as in grief and consolation, storm and calm. It would be non- sense if a deep religious sentiment were expressed by the first theme, only to be succeeded in the second theme by suggestions of a bacchanalian feast. Succeeding the middle theme, another interlude of suitable character is to be introduced (usually longer than the first, though not necessarily so); lead- ing to another or Closing Theme, still different in rhythm from the others, but in the same related mode as that used in the middle theme. This theme, some- tiues long and sometimes very short, closes Part I, of the First movement. SCHEME OF PART I. FIRST MOVEMENT. Principal Theme ^ f iliddle Theme 1 f Closing Theme. Conclu- iu the > Interlude, Modulation. < in a > Interlude. < siou in the same mode principal mode. ) ( related mode. ) (as the Middle Theme. Part I, may be repeated or not, at pleasure. In Sonatas of very great scope, the principal, as well as the middle and clos- ing themes, are sometimes again divided into diverse parts, in the same key, but of different rhythm. These difierent themes are most surely recognized through the different ap- pearing modes and rhythms, (see scheme). PART* II. (FIRST MOVEMENT, ANTITHESIS.) In this part, properly no new motives are to appear, but rather the thematic development of those found in Part I. These are to be set in combat, or con- test, so to speak, one with the other, and the freest license given to their evo- lution and to the range of modulation. This having been carried far enough, the complication now clears itself up. A modulation follows, leading back to the principal key, with which the principal theme (of I'art I.) again enters, followed by the same or a similar interlude to the first; then the middle theme again, but this time in the principal key, or, in a key related to that first em- ployed; then the same interlude as at first after the middle theme, succeeded by the closing theme of Part I, but now in the principal key. (It will be self-understood that there is nothing strictly arbitrary here, but that all these parts are subject to more or less variation, abbreviation, or ex- tension.) Now follows a Coda, in which, the character of the whole move- MANUAL' OF MUSICAL THEORY. 281 ment is to be strongly portrayed, and also, in which, remembrances of the most important moments are to be called up, closing naturally in the principal key. An introduction, generally of slower tempo, often precedes this First move- ment, the character of which should bring the auditor into the proper frame of mind for that which is to follow. SCHEME OF THE ENTIRE FIRST MOVEMENT OF A SONATA. PAKT I. /Intro- N C Priuc. Theme ( Tt.(- -m^a > Middle Theme. ^T„^■a■^^„A^ 5 Closing Theme, s.ime • Uuction.JI " Key. jInt-.^o<»-^ Related Key. j ^^^terlude. ^ j^^^ ^^ ^j^^^jj^ ^'jj^^^p ; 1 1 PART n. I Thematic ) ( t> ti t C Middle Theme. ) ( Closing Theme. ) 1 1 Develop- \ Mod. •< .T" :L"orao. r interlade. < Princ, or > Int. < Principal Key. } Coda. 1 1 ment. ) ( ^ej. ^ ^ related Key. ) ( ) ll Remaek. — A more important Andante, Adagio, etc., or even Scherzo, sometimes have the same form as the above. Succeeding the above, come other movements ; an Andante (II.), for ex- ample, then a Scherzo or Minuett, (III.) or vice versa, etc., and, lastly, THE FINALE OR RONDO. In the finale, the result or predominating character of the preceding move- ments should be declared in the principal theme. All the ■ interludes in this movement are to be reflective of this theme, and all secondary themes are to strive continually towards or cluster around it. It may, therefore, appear an indefinite number of times, according to the length of the movement. The following synopsis and scheme will serve as a model for a very broadly developed Finale or Rondo. First, the principal theme in the principal key, followed by an interlude, and this by the principal theme again. Now comes a connective phrase, leading into a middle theme in a related mode; again, a connective phrase leading to a repetition of the principal theme; this is to be succeeded by passages or ca- denzas, thematic treatment ajid modulations, as in the First Movement, lead- ing again to the principal theme in the principal key; now an interlude and the repetition of the middle theme, but this time in the principal or a related key to that first used; another interlude, the principal theme again, passages or cadenzas, and finally a well-developed closing theme in which the principal one may again be remembered. SCHEME OF A RONDO OR FINALE. Theme.) ( ) f Middle Th.) f Theme. ) C Thematic 1 Princ. > Interlude. < Theme, interlude. < Related Sinter. < Princ. > Inter. < treatment. \ Key. ) t ) t Key. ) ( Key. > (Modulations. > c ) f Middle Theme) C Theme ) C Closins Theme. ) < Theme. > Interlude. < in principal or \ Interlude. < principal > Interlude. < Reminder of > ( ) ( related Key. J ( Key. ) ( Principal Theme. ) 282 MANUAL OF MUSICAL TBEOBT. In less important Rondos the principal theme need not occur so frequently as in the above scheme. The interludes will fall away proportionately, the thematic development and one of the occurrences of the middle theme may be omitted. Rondos are to be found in which a middle theme is only hinted at. As a Sonata means nothing more than a piece of instrumental music, so the succession above given may be quite altered. There are Sonatas in which the First movement is a Theme vfith Variatiom^, (for example, Beethoven's A^. Sonata, Op. 26), or an Adagio, (Op. 27, No. 2, in C^ Minor, Beethoven), or, in which the last movement is a Theme with Variations, (E Major, Op. 109, Beethoven), etc. The form given above, however, is the most practical, and the one oftenest used. When the pupil desires to set himself at work to compose a Sonata, the best of all plans is to take, as a model, one of the Sonatas of Beethoven, not simply to follow or imitate measure for measure, but to work according to the form or general outline thereof, — the entrance of the themes, their development, the formation of the passages or interludes, the modulations, etc. THE OVERTURE TO AN OPERA OR DRAMA. The purpose of the Overture is to foreshadow the character, or tone-colour. of the succeeding Opera or Drama. Its form is frequently identical with that of the first movement of a Sonata, with an Introduction, and its themes, in the case of the Opera, are generally those which are afterward heard in the Opera itself. VARIATIONS. The term means alterations. As a foundation, it is usual to take a simple expressive theme, frequently of two parts of eight measures each. An Intro- duction often precedes, and the variations are always to retain the tone-colour of the theme, but in a more subdued or more intensified voicing. The variations are to be effected as follows: — I, In the Melody. III. In the Meter and Rhythm. II. In the Harmony. IV. In the Key. I. (1) The melody or theme, which may appear in any of the voices, oftei>- est, however, in the upper voice, may be made milder, more expressive; (2) it can be ornamented to any extent; (3) it may be divided or cut up into contin- uous passage forms; (4) the various voices may alternate or answer each other in these figurated passages. MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. 283 n. Harmony. (1) To the given melody a new harmony can be applied. (2) The melody may be placed in other voices and still "other harmonies used. III. ITeter and Bhythm. (1) A three-part meter can be changed to | or g, and vice versa, etc. (2) The rhythm of the theme may be enlivened or made more sedate, even to the extremest points. I Y. Key, etc. A theme given out in major may be varied in related minor modes, and vice versa. Further, variations can be effected through use of the various technical char- acteristics of the instrument employed. The whole or a part of the theme may be used as a subject for Canons or Fugues. Finally, as a last variation, the theme, harmonically and rhythmically deco- rated, may form the principal theme for an extended Finale or Rondo. In Yariations, as well as in all compositions, of artistic worth, a defined, united character or voicing must never be wanting. A composition in which the character changes abruptly, as in a potpourri, has no artistic value. CHAPTER XL. CONCERNING THE MODULATIONS OR .CHANGES OF KEY IN A COMPOSITION. It is always well at the beginning of a composition, to firmly establish the mode to be used. At the end, we should feel that the piece has arrived at a perfect repose in the same key. It is against all sound sense to begin and end a composition in different keys, and yet, numerous examples of this kind are not difficult to find. In the midst of a composition, there should ap- pear, at least, one modulatory phrase. This is most frequently to the Key of the Dominant, — in major to the major Dominant, and in minor to the major or minor (the last is the best) Dominant. In shorter pieces, for example, Folk songs, this modulation is sometimes on- ly indicated by the Dominant accord. In compositions of somewhat greater importance, the modulation may touch all the next-related modes, as per following scheme, C major being regarded as the principal mode: — (d)— F— A— C— E— G 284 MANUAL OF MUSICAL THEORY. Here, we would again remind the pupil that a Trio or Middle Theme should not ordinarily appear in the Key of the Sub-dominant. This, however, does not hinder the transient appearance of this key in the course of the modulation. In compositions, where the principal mode is broadly presented at the be- ginning and end, the modulation may extend to still more distant keys. We have already mentioned the modes related in the third and fifth. To these we will now add the similar-named modes. In C major we must add to those above given, A and E major, F minor, (G minor is too foreign to be counted in this grade of relationship), and C mi- nor, also the modes related in the third to the last, — Alz and El2 major, (see scheme). RELATED MODES TO C MAJOR. A E (D)_r— i— C— E— G— or ... . F— Alz— C— EI2— G. RELATED MODES TO A MINOR, A D— F— A— C— E (G) or ... . D— fJ— 1— cj(— E. F The relationships of a mode seem to divide themselves into two sides, accord- ing to the above schemes, and it is not always judicious to cause the modula- tion to touch first one side and then the other. For example, it would not be acceptable if the Middle Theme in the first movement of a Sonata appeared first in E major and afterward in A|2 major, (rather A major), as these keys are not directly related. Finally, in compositions, of extraordinary breadth, all modes maybe touched provided, that they follow each other in rational order, not like C major, Fjf minor, EI2 major, etc, but rather in thirds and fifths, as above explained. We have said that these various modes may be touched. We mean by that to guard against the important or extended appearance of too many, as this would only cause confusion and disaster to the entire composition. In conclusion, we would repeat the well-known maxim: — "PROVE ALL THINGS AND HOLD FAST THAT WHICH IS BEST." 285 ALPHABETICAL INDEX. Abbreviations, 18-19. Absolute Pitch, 12. Accents, Table of, 54-9. Accidentals, 41. Accord, (see chord) 22, 35. Accompaniment, Harmonic, to a given interval as cantus firmns, 131-8 ; to major scalea, 138- 41; to minor scale.s, 141-2; to chromatic scale, 143-4 ; to anj' cantus firmus, 145-6. Accompaniment Forms, 240-3. Altered Accords. 233-6. Anticipation, 172. Antithesis, 62-3, 276-SO. Appopgiatura, 77, 85. Arpeggios, 76. Augmented Intervals, 28, 29, 33-34 ; inversion of, 31, 33-34. Augmented Sixth Accord, 127. Authentic Cadence, 93-9. Auxiliary Tones, 77. Augmented Triad, ita intervals, 37, 45; its treat- ment, 126. IB. Bars, Double Sars, 15. . Beginning and End in melody, 61-65 ; in connter- point, two-voieeil, 244-46; three-voiced, 257; four-voiced (see Harmonic Cadences). Bi-measural Rhythm, 55-6. Bolder Minor Mode, 44-5. Bound Dissonances, Bound Saspensions, 146-59. Brace, 40. Broken Chords (Arpeggios), 76. Cadences, Deceptive, 2;<, 188-90; Melodic, 61-2; Harmonic, 98-102 ; in two voices, 245 ; in three voices, 257. Caesura. 55. Chord. 22, 35 (see Accord). Chord Connection, Rule of, 79. Chord of the Augmented Sixth, 127-8; Third Fourth and Aug. Sixth, 128 ; Fifth and Aug. Sixth, 128 ; of the Seventh (see Seventh Ac- cords). Chromatic Hal/step, 27. Chromatic Tones and Scale, 38. Clefs, 9-10. Close Position. 69. Compass of Voices, 68. Complete Cadence, 100. Composition Forms, 276-83. Concerto. 278-9. Consonance. 22. Consonant Triad, 37, 67. Consonant Fourth in Connter-point, in two voi- ces, 243-4; in three voices, 256, 253. Consecutive Octaves and Unisons, 75, 81, 242, 246-7, 2.52, 271. Consecutive Fifths, 75, 81, 207, 243, 246-7, 25-..'. Contrary Motion, 74. Counterpoint, Science of, 23 ; two-voiced, 24.3-53 three-voiced, 254-.C5 ; four-voiced, 265-7t , more than four, 271-5. Covered Octaves, 75, 81. 244, 256, 266. 271-2. Covered Fifths, 232, 237, 248, 75-6, 81, 244, 256, 260. 271-2. Cross Pclation, 110-11. D. Dance Form, 277-8. Deceptive Cadence, 23, 188-90. Degree-ivise, 74. Depression to Relative Degrees, 90-1. Determination of Major Intervals, 23- Development of a Melody, 237-40. Diatonic Half-step, 27. Diatonic Scale, 38. Diminution, 14. Diminished Intervals, 28, 32-4 ; table of, 29 ; in- version of, 31. Diminished Triad, its intervals, 37 : treatment of, 125-6. Diminished Seventh Accord, 208-28 ; its ambigui- ty, 211; in modulation, 212-25; notation of, 215 : in organ-point, 227-8 ; succes.sion of. 227. Dissonance, definition of, 22; bound, 146-59 Dissonant Triads, 125-7. Dispersed Position, 69. Dominant, 25-6. Dominant Seventh Accord, 160-83; primary reso- lution of, 162-5 ; omission and duplication in, 165 ; entrance and resolution after the tonic- triad of its own mode, 166-8; applii^ation ol suspensions to, 168-73 ; entrance aud resolu- tion after other triads of its own mode, 173- 5 ; entrance and resolution of Dom. Seventi accord, of dilferent modes after the same triad, 176-83 ; secondary resolutions Of, 183- 8 ; application in modulation, 167-8 ; in de- ceptive cadences 188-90; in cadences. 202 ; 8 accession of, 190. Doitble Bars, 15. Dot, 13-14. Duplication of Tones, 73, 163, 165, 244, 254-5, 265- 6, 271-5. Dynamics, 17. K3. Ecclesiastical Scales, 25. Elevation to Relative Degrees, 9J-4. Eleventh, So-called Chord of, 231. Enharmonic; Tones. 38. Enharmonic Change, 143-4, 183. Entablature, German, 12. Establishment of Tone System, 23-5. Even Temperament, 27. Expressimi Words of, 17; signs ofi 17. Esetension of Tone System, 26. 288 ALPHABETICAL INDEX. Figure (Motive), 21. Figured Boss (Thorough Bass), 71-3. Fifths, coii.secutive (.see under C, consecutive and covereil tifths). Fifth-Hixth position of Seventh accords, IGl ; its resoliitiuu, lti4. Finale, -2til. FlaUi, S ; generation of, in signature, in major, 39-43 ; in minor, 46-9. Formation of Melodies, 62-5. Forms of Accorii;jani)iient, 240-3. Fornix of 6'o?/i2'(/si Unison, 19, 271. TT. YariMiont, 282-3. Vibrating Siring;, 24. Voices, 67-8 ; c^mpasf of Voiej Motion, 74-5 ; 944. ^W Whole fiep, ''. Words »f Fxprttei'm, Vt. Warren, Mutic SterectyPer^ 43 Centre St, N. K aENEKA-L INDEX. PAET I. Elementary. ^^^^ °^""^L Material of Music. Tone System. Notation. General Intervals. De- ^ n. Theorr^SSSlSS^f^nsi^of To;^eSyBU^--cias^fication ^^ of Specific Intervals ' 30 nL Inversion of Intervals PAET II. Harmony. . 35 IV. Triads. Mode. Scales. ........... •.••• 39 V Si'^nature. Normal Major Mode and bcale •••• ^^ VL* No"rmal Minor Mode and Minor Scales • • g VTT ^ianature in Minor Modes. Parallel Modes v£ leTated Iccords and Modes. Similar-named Modes |1 1 ?:^^atio^n^1\"elodi;L' ' Mdodlc PassageV and Ca^^^^^^^^^^^^ BO ^T Thrronsonant Triad. Various Positions of Triads. '' ' S plured Bass Duplication and Omission. Voice Motion 71 Wl iileSof Auxiliary Tones Appoggiatura. Passing Notes 76 irV. Harmonic Connection. Triad Succession • • • ■ • gg XV. Harmonic Cadences 102 XVI. Modulation • •• 113 XVIL Modulation to more distant Keys. W" V ' 129 XVin! Succession of Triads not common to the same Mode. ; ; ; ; [ ; ! 125 XIX. Dissonant Triads : • ; o' Vl' "fV '. 1^7 XX. Chord of the Augmented Sixth, etc ^^y S. Sc° Sii;-Ha™iiic AicompanlmenVi.- a'giVVn Mdody 1 . ! 131 IS?: gSrorthe SeVeni: ' 'iA:,^ ij.'^^e V.o^C^ ^Vekib 1=9 XXV. Dominant Seventh Accord. (Continued) ^ _ ^^3 XXvi. Dominant Seventh Accord *' ' .".*."].'.. 176 XXVn. Dominant Seventh Accord m Modulation. jg3 ^VIII Secondary resolution of Seventh Accords _ ^gg ^ SSigS^e^enu; Accorii^rn^^oii^:::::::::::::-' z S^ iSSISrS ^Si£h;Ei;v;nih;^d Tiii;^;^::::::::^^ ^ yYYTTT. Altered Accords • PAET m. Counterpoint. , 237 XXXIV. Development of a single voice. Accompaniments ;;;;;;;;; 243 XXXV. Two-voiced Movements i i ' ! . . . . 254 XXXVL Three-voiced Movements *'.'.'.*.*.. 265 XXXVTL Four-voiced Movements _ _ _ 271 XXXVUL Movements for more than four voices PAET TV. Composition. ..• . 276 XXXIX. Synopsis of the Forms of Composition. "**'.',... 283 XL. Modulation8 in a Composition 285 Alphabetical Index. **.'.'.'.'.*.*.*.*.*.*. 288 Generallndex 117 RETURN TO the circulation desk of any University of California Library or to the NORTHERN REGIONAL LIBRARY FACILITY University of California Richmond Field Station, BIdg. 400 1301 South 46th Street Richmond, CA 94804-4698 ALL BOOKS MAY BE RECALLED AFTER 7 DAYS To renew or recharge your library materials, you may contact NRLF 4 days prior to due date at (510) 642-6233 Diiffi>ek6; STAMPED BELOW SEP 2 5 2007 DD20 12M 7-06 ' 1/^ y-b * DATE DUE Music Library University of California at Berkeley